blob: bd4f851442f34fc8bb95f109d810b1e985b973e1 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaueab1dc62013-06-17 15:10:25 +02007 2013/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200468 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - noepoll
470 - nokqueue
471 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200473 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200474 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200475 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100476 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100477 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200478 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100479 - tune.maxaccept
480 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200481 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200482 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100483 - tune.rcvbuf.client
484 - tune.rcvbuf.server
485 - tune.sndbuf.client
486 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100487 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100488 - tune.ssl.lifetime
489 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100490 - tune.zlib.memlevel
491 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493 * Debugging
494 - debug
495 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496
497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004983.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499------------------------------------
500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501ca-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200503 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
504 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506chroot <jail dir>
507 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
508 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
509 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
510 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
511 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
512 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100513
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100514cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
515 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
516 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
517 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
518 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
519 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
520 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
521 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
522 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
523 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
524 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
525 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
526 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
527 they overlap.
528
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200529crt-base <dir>
530 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
531 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
532 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200534daemon
535 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
536 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
537 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
538
539gid <number>
540 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
541 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
542 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100543 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
544 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547group <group name>
548 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
549 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100550
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200551log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
553 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100554 configured with "log global".
555
556 <address> can be one of:
557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100558 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100559 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
560 port).
561
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100562 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
563 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
564 port).
565
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
567 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
568 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
569 writeable).
570
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100571 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
572 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
573 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
574 in Bourne shell.
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577
578 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
579 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
580 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
581
582 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200583 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
584 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
585 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
586 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
587 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
588 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200590 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100592log-send-hostname [<string>]
593 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
594 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
595 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
596 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
597 the logs.
598
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000599log-tag <string>
600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
601 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
602 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
603 running on the same host.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605nbproc <number>
606 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
607 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
608 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
609 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
610 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
611
612pidfile <pidfile>
613 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
614 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
615 starting the process. See also "daemon".
616
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100617stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200618 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
619 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
620 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
621 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
622 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
623 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
624 the number of processes used.
625
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200626stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
627 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
628 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
629 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
630 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200631
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200632 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
633 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
634 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200635
636stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
637 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
638 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100639 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200640
641stats maxconn <connections>
642 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
643 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645uid <number>
646 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
647 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
648 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
649 one. See also "gid" and "user".
650
651ulimit-n <number>
652 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
653 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
654 option.
655
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100656unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
657 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
658
659 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
660 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
661 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
662 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
663 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
664 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
665 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
666 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
667 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
668 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670user <user name>
671 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
672 See also "uid" and "group".
673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200674node <name>
675 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
676
677 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
678 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
679 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
680 traffic.
681
682description <text>
683 Add a text that describes the instance.
684
685 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
686 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
687 "<" and ">" characters.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691-----------------------
692
693maxconn <number>
694 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
695 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
696 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
697 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200699maxconnrate <number>
700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
707 fairness.
708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100709maxcomprate <number>
710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
711 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
716 default value.
717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100718maxcompcpuusage <number>
719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728maxpipes <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
735
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200736maxsslconn <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
738 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
739 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
740 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
741 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
742 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
743 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
744
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100745maxzlibmem <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
747 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
748 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100749 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
750 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
751 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753noepoll
754 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
755 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
758nokqueue
759 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
760 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
761 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
762
763nopoll
764 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
765 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100766 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100767 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769nosplice
770 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
771 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
772 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100773 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100774 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
775 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
776 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
777 "option splice-response".
778
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200779spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
780 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
781 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
782 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
783 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
784 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
785
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200786tune.bufsize <number>
787 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
788 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
789 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
790 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
791 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
792 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
793 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
794 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400795 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
796 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
797 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200798
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200799tune.chksize <number>
800 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
801 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
802 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
803 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
804 checks whenever possible.
805
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100806tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
807 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
808 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
809 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
810 this value. The default value is 1.
811
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100812tune.http.cookielen <number>
813 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
814 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
815 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
816 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
817 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
818 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
819 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
820 to change this value.
821
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200822tune.http.maxhdr <number>
823 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
824 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
825 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
826 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
827 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
828 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
829 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
830 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
831 limit too high.
832
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100833tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100834 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
835 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
836 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
837 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
838 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
839 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
840 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
841 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
842 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
843 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100844
845tune.maxpollevents <number>
846 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
847 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
848 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
849 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
850 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
851
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200852tune.maxrewrite <number>
853 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
854 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
855 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
856 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
857 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
858 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
859 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
860 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
861 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
862 bufsize.
863
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200864tune.pipesize <number>
865 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
866 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
867 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
868 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
869 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
870 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
871
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100872tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
873tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
874 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
875 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
876 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
877 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
878 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
879 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
880 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
881
882tune.sndbuf.client <number>
883tune.sndbuf.server <number>
884 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
885 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
886 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
887 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
888 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
889 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
890 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
891 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
892 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
893 notifying haproxy again.
894
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100895tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100896 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
897 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
898 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
899 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
900 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
901 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
902 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
903 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
904 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100905 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
906 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100907
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100908tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
909 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
910 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
911 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
912 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
913 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
914 being used for too long.
915
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100916tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
917 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
918 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
919 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
920 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
921 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
922 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
923 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
924 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
925 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
926 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
927 best value.
928
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100929tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
930 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
931 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
932 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
933 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
934 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
935
936tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
937 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
938 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
939 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
940 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009423.3. Debugging
943--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944
945debug
946 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
947 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
948 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
949 system startup.
950
951quiet
952 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
953 line argument "-q".
954
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009563.4. Userlists
957--------------
958It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
959http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
960it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
961
962userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100963 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100964 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
965
966group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100967 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100968 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
969 proceeded by "users" keyword.
970
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100971user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
972 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100973 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
974 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100975 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
976 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100977 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
978 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
979
980
981 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100982 userlist L1
983 group G1 users tiger,scott
984 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100985
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100986 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
987 user scott insecure-password elgato
988 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100989
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100990 userlist L2
991 group G1
992 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100993
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100994 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
995 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
996 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100997
998 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001000
10013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001002----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001003It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1004haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1005pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1006identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1007or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1008Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1009known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1010the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1011process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1012during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1013tables.
1014
1015peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001016 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001017 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1018
1019peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1020 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1021 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1022 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1023 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1024 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1025 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1026
1027 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1028 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1029
1030 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1031 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1032 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1033 across all peers.
1034
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001035 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1036 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1037 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1038
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001039 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001040 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001041 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1042 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1043 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001044
1045 backend mybackend
1046 mode tcp
1047 balance roundrobin
1048 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1049 stick on src
1050
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001051 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1052 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001053
1054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010554. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001057
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1059 - defaults <name>
1060 - frontend <name>
1061 - backend <name>
1062 - listen <name>
1063
1064A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1065its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1066section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001067section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
1069A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1070connections.
1071
1072A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1073to forward incoming connections.
1074
1075A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1076parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001078All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1079'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1080case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1081
1082Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1083logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1084proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1085However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1086name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1087
1088Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1089and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001090bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001091protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1092modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1093arbitrary criteria.
1094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010964.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1097--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001099The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1100limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1101they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1102limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001104option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001105and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1106with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1107specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001108
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001110 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1111------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1112acl - X X X
1113appsession - - X X
1114backlog X X X -
1115balance X - X X
1116bind - X X -
1117bind-process X X X X
1118block - X X X
1119capture cookie - X X -
1120capture request header - X X -
1121capture response header - X X -
1122clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001123compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1125cookie X - X X
1126default-server X - X X
1127default_backend X X X -
1128description - X X X
1129disabled X X X X
1130dispatch - - X X
1131enabled X X X X
1132errorfile X X X X
1133errorloc X X X X
1134errorloc302 X X X X
1135-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1136errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001137force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001138fullconn X - X X
1139grace X X X X
1140hash-type X - X X
1141http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001142http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001143http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001144http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001145http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001146id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001147ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001148log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001149maxconn X X X -
1150mode X X X X
1151monitor fail - X X -
1152monitor-net X X X -
1153monitor-uri X X X -
1154option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1155option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1156option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1157option allbackups (*) X - X X
1158option checkcache (*) X - X X
1159option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1160option contstats (*) X X X -
1161option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1162option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1163option forceclose (*) X X X X
1164-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1165option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001166option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001167option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001168option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1169option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1170option httpchk X - X X
1171option httpclose (*) X X X X
1172option httplog X X X X
1173option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001174option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09001175option lb-agent-chk X - X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001176option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001177option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1178option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1179option logasap (*) X X X -
1180option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001181option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001182option nolinger (*) X X X X
1183option originalto X X X X
1184option persist (*) X - X X
1185option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001186option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001187option smtpchk X - X X
1188option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1189option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1190option splice-request (*) X X X X
1191option splice-response (*) X X X X
1192option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1193option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1194-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1195option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1196option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1197option tcpka X X X X
1198option tcplog X X X X
1199option transparent (*) X - X X
1200persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1201rate-limit sessions X X X -
1202redirect - X X X
1203redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1204redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1205reqadd - X X X
1206reqallow - X X X
1207reqdel - X X X
1208reqdeny - X X X
1209reqiallow - X X X
1210reqidel - X X X
1211reqideny - X X X
1212reqipass - X X X
1213reqirep - X X X
1214reqisetbe - X X X
1215reqitarpit - X X X
1216reqpass - X X X
1217reqrep - X X X
1218-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1219reqsetbe - X X X
1220reqtarpit - X X X
1221retries X - X X
1222rspadd - X X X
1223rspdel - X X X
1224rspdeny - X X X
1225rspidel - X X X
1226rspideny - X X X
1227rspirep - X X X
1228rsprep - X X X
1229server - - X X
1230source X - X X
1231srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001232stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001233stats auth X - X X
1234stats enable X - X X
1235stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001236stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001237stats realm X - X X
1238stats refresh X - X X
1239stats scope X - X X
1240stats show-desc X - X X
1241stats show-legends X - X X
1242stats show-node X - X X
1243stats uri X - X X
1244-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1245stick match - - X X
1246stick on - - X X
1247stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001248stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001249stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001250tcp-request connection - X X -
1251tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001252tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001253tcp-response content - - X X
1254tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001255timeout check X - X X
1256timeout client X X X -
1257timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1258timeout connect X - X X
1259timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1260timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1261timeout http-request X X X X
1262timeout queue X - X X
1263timeout server X - X X
1264timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1265timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001266timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001267transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001268unique-id-format X X X -
1269unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001270use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001271use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001272------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1273 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012764.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1277---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001278
1279This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1280
1281
1282acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1283 Declare or complete an access list.
1284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1285 no | yes | yes | yes
1286 Example:
1287 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1288 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1289 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001291 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001292
1293
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001294appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1295 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001296 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1298 no | no | yes | yes
1299 Arguments :
1300 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1301 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1302
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001303 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001304 checked in each cookie value.
1305
1306 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1307 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1308 milliseconds.
1309
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001310 request-learn
1311 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1312 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1313 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1314 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1315 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1316 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1317
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001318 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1319 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1320 data following this prefix.
1321
1322 Example :
1323 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1324
1325 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1326 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1327
1328 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1329 2 modes are currently supported :
1330 - path-parameters :
1331 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1332 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1333 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1334 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1335 - query-string :
1336 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1337 query string.
1338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001339 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1340 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1341 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1342 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001343 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1344 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1345 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001346 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1347 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1348
1349 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1350
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001351 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1352 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1353 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001355 Example :
1356 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1357
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001358 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1359 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001360
1361
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001362backlog <conns>
1363 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1365 yes | yes | yes | no
1366 Arguments :
1367 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1368 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001369 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001370
1371 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1372 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1373 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1374 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1375 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1376 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1377 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1378 backlog parameter.
1379
1380 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1381 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1382 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1383
1384 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1385
1386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001387balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001388balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001389 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1391 yes | no | yes | yes
1392 Arguments :
1393 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1394 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1395 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1396 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1397
1398 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1399 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1400 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1401 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001402 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001403 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001404 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1405 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1406 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1407 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1408 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1409 it, so that you don't worry.
1410
1411 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1412 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1413 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1414 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1415 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1416 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1417 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1418 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001419
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001420 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1421 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1422 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1423 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1424 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1425 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1426 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1427 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1428
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001429 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1430 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1431 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1432 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001433 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001434 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1435 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1436 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1437 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1438 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001439 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1440 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1441 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1442 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1443 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1444 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001445
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001446 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1447 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1448 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1449 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1450 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1451 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1452 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1453 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001454 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001455 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001456 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1457 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1458 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001460 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1461 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1462 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1463 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1464 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1465 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1466 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1467 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1468 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1469 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1470 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1471 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001472
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001473 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001474 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1475 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1476 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1477 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1478 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1479 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1480 URIs start with a leading "/".
1481
1482 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1483 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1484 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1485 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1486
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001488 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1489
1490 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001491 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1492 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1493 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1494 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1495 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1496 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1497 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1498 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1499 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1500 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1501 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1502 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1503 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1504 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1505 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1506 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1507 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1508 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1509 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001510
1511 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1512 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1513 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1514 server will receive the request.
1515
1516 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1517 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1518 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1519 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1520 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001521 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1522 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1523 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001524
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001525 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1526 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1527 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1528 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1529 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001531 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001532 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1533 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1534 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1535
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001536 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1537 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1538 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1539
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001540 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001541 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001542 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1543 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1544 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1545 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1546 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1547 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001548 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001549 used instead.
1550
1551 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1552 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1553 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1554 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1555
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001556 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1557 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1558 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1559
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001560 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001562 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001563 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1564 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001565
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001566 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001567 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001568
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001569 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1570 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1571 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001572
1573 Examples :
1574 balance roundrobin
1575 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001576 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001577 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1578 balance hdr(host)
1579 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001580
1581 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1582 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001584 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001585 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1586 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1587 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1588 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1589
1590 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1591 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1592 defaults to 16 kB.
1593
1594 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1595 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1596
1597 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1598 Round Robin.
1599
1600 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1601 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1602 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1603 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1604
1605 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1606
1607 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001608 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001609 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1610 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1611 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001612
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001613 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1614 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615
1616
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001617bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1618bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001619 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1621 no | yes | yes | no
1622 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001623 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1624 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1625 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1626 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001627 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001628 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1629 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1630 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1631 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1632 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1633 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1634 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001635 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1636 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1637 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001638 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1639 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1640 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1641 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001642
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001643 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1644 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001645 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1646 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1647 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001648 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1649 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1650 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1651 the range.
1652
1653 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1654 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1655 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1656 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1657 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1658 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1659 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001660 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001661 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001662
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001663 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1664 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1665 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1666 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1667 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1668 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1669 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1670 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1671
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001672 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1673 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1674 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1675 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001677 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1678 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1679 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1680 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1681 in a frontend.
1682
1683 Example :
1684 listen http_proxy
1685 bind :80,:443
1686 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001687 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001688
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001689 listen http_https_proxy
1690 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001691 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001692
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001693 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1694 bind ipv6@:80
1695 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1696 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1697
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001698 listen external_bind_app1
1699 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1700
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001701 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001702 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001703
1704
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001705bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001706 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1708 yes | yes | yes | yes
1709 Arguments :
1710 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1711 may be used to override a default value.
1712
1713 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1714 option may be combined with other numbers.
1715
1716 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1717 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1718 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1719 missing from all processes.
1720
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001721 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1722 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1723 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1724 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1725 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001726
1727 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1728 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1729 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1730 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1731 and 'even' instances.
1732
1733 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1734 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1735 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1736 32.
1737
1738 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1739 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1740
1741 Example :
1742 listen app_ip1
1743 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001744 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001745
1746 listen app_ip2
1747 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001748 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001749
1750 listen management
1751 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001752 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001753
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001754 listen management
1755 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1756 bind-process 1-4
1757
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001758 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1759
1760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761block { if | unless } <condition>
1762 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1764 no | yes | yes | yes
1765
1766 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1767 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001768 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001769 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001770 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1771 "block" statements per instance.
1772
1773 Example:
1774 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1775 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1776 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1777 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001779 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
1781
1782capture cookie <name> len <length>
1783 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1785 no | yes | yes | no
1786 Arguments :
1787 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1788 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1789 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1790 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1791 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1792
1793 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1794 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1795 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1796 right if it exceeds <length>.
1797
1798 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1799 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1800 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1801 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1802
1803 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1804 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1805 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1806
1807 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1808 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1809 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001810 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1811 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1812 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001813
1814 Example:
1815 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1816
1817 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001818 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819
1820
1821capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001822 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1824 no | yes | yes | no
1825 Arguments :
1826 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001827 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1829 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1830 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1831
1832 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1833 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1834 it exceeds <length>.
1835
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001836 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1838 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001839 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1840 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1841 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1842 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001843 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001844 environments to find where the request came from.
1845
1846 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1847 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1848 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1849 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001850
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001851 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1852 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1853 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1854 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1855 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001856
1857 Example:
1858 capture request header Host len 15
1859 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1860 capture request header Referrer len 15
1861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001862 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001863 about logging.
1864
1865
1866capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001867 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1869 no | yes | yes | no
1870 Arguments :
1871 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001872 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1874 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1875 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1876
1877 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1878 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1879 it exceeds <length>.
1880
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001881 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001882 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1883 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1884 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001885 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1886 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1887 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1888 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001890 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1891 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1892 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1893 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1894 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
1896 Example:
1897 capture response header Content-length len 9
1898 capture response header Location len 15
1899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001900 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901 about logging.
1902
1903
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001904clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001905 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1907 yes | yes | yes | no
1908 Arguments :
1909 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1910 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1911 as explained at the top of this document.
1912
1913 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1914 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1915 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1916 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1917 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1918 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1919 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1920 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001921 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001922 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1923 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1924
1925 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1926 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1927 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1928 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1929 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1930 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1931
1932 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1933 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1934
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001935 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1936 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001937
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001938compression algo <algorithm> ...
1939compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001940compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001941 Enable HTTP compression.
1942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1943 yes | yes | yes | yes
1944 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001945 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1946 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1947 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1948
1949 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001950 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001951 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1952 data.
1953
1954 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1955 support for zlib was built in.
1956
1957 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1958 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1959 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1960 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1961 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1962 in.
1963
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001964 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001965 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001966 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1967 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1968 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1969 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1970 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001971
1972 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1973 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1974 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1975 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1976 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001977 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1978 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1979 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1980 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1981 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1982 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001983
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001984 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001985 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1986 "Accept-Encoding" header
1987 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001988 * HTTP status code is not 200
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001989 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1990 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1991 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1992 "multipart"
1993 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
1994 header
1995 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
1996 and later
1997 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
1998 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001999
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002000 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2001 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002002
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002003 Examples :
2004 compression algo gzip
2005 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002006
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002007contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2010 yes | no | yes | yes
2011 Arguments :
2012 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2013 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2014 as explained at the top of this document.
2015
2016 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002017 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002018 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2020 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2021 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2022 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2023
2024 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2025 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2026 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2027 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2028 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2029 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2030
2031 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2032 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2033 instead.
2034
2035 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2036 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2037
2038
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002039cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002040 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2041 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2044 yes | no | yes | yes
2045 Arguments :
2046 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2047 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2048 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2049 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2050 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2051 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2052 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2053 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2054 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2055
2056 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2057 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2058 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2059 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2060 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2061 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2062 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2063 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2064 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2065 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2066 "insert" and "prefix".
2067
2068 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002069 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002070
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002071 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002072 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2073 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2074 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2075 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2076 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2077 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2078 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2079 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2080 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2081 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002082
2083 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2084 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2085 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2086 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2087 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2088 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2089 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2090 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2091 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2092 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002093 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2094 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2095 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002097 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2098 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2099 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002100 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2101 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2102 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2103 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002104 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2105 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2106 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002107
2108 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2109 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2110 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2111 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2112 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2113 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2114 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2115 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2116 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2117
2118 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2119 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2120 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2121 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2122 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2123 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2124 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2125 persistence cookie in the cache.
2126 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2127
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002128 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2129 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2130 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2131 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2132 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2133 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2134 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2135 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2136 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2137 they logout.
2138
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002139 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2140 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2141 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2142 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2143
2144 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2145 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2146 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2147 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2148 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2149 this attribute.
2150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002151 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002152 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002153 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2154 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2155 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2156 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2157 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2158 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002159
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002160 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2161 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2162 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2163 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2164 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2165 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2166 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2167 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2168 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2169 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2170 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2171 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2172 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2173 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2174 the site.
2175
2176 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2177 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2178 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2179 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2180 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2181 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2182 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2183 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2184 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2185 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2186 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2187 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2188 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2189 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2190 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2191 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002193 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2194 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2195 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2196 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198 Examples :
2199 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2200 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2201 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002202 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002203
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002204 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002205 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002208default-server [param*]
2209 Change default options for a server in a backend
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2211 yes | no | yes | yes
2212 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002213 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2214 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2215 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2216 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002217
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002218 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002219 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2220
2221 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002222
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002223
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224default_backend <backend>
2225 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2227 yes | yes | yes | no
2228 Arguments :
2229 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2230
2231 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2232 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2233 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2234 will catch all undetermined requests.
2235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002236 Example :
2237
2238 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2239 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2240 default_backend dynamic
2241
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002242 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244
2245disabled
2246 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2248 yes | yes | yes | yes
2249 Arguments : none
2250
2251 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2252 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2253 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2254 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2255 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2256 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2257 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2258
2259 See also : "enabled"
2260
2261
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002262dispatch <address>:<port>
2263 Set a default server address
2264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2265 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002266 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002267
2268 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2269 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2270 during start-up.
2271
2272 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2273 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2274 possible with normal servers.
2275
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002276 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002277 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2278 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2279 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2280 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2281
2282 See also : "server"
2283
2284
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002285enabled
2286 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2288 yes | yes | yes | yes
2289 Arguments : none
2290
2291 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2292 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2293
2294 See also : "disabled"
2295
2296
2297errorfile <code> <file>
2298 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2300 yes | yes | yes | yes
2301 Arguments :
2302 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002303 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304
2305 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002306 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002308 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2309 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310
2311 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2312 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2313 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2314
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002315 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002317 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2318 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2319 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2320 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2321
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002322 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2323 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2324 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2325 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2326 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2327 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2330 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2331 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002332 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2334
2335 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2336
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002337 Example :
2338 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2339 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2340 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2341
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002342
2343errorloc <code> <url>
2344errorloc302 <code> <url>
2345 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2347 yes | yes | yes | yes
2348 Arguments :
2349 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002350 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002351
2352 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2353 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2354 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2355 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2356 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2357
2358 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2359 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2360 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2361
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002362 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2363
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002364 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2365 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2366 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2367 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2368 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2369 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2370 request.
2371
2372 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2373
2374
2375errorloc303 <code> <url>
2376 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2378 yes | yes | yes | yes
2379 Arguments :
2380 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2381 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2382
2383 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2384 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2385 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2386 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2387 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2388
2389 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2390 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2391 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2392
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002393 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2394
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002395 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2396 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2397 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2398 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002399 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002400
2401 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2402
2403
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002404force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2405 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2406 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2407 no | yes | yes | yes
2408
2409 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2410 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2411 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2412 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2413 marked down for maintenance operations.
2414
2415 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2416 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2417 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2418 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2419 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2420 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2421 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2422 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2423 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2424
2425 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2426 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2427 is used.
2428
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002429 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002430 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002431
2432
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002433fullconn <conns>
2434 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2436 yes | no | yes | yes
2437 Arguments :
2438 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2439 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2440
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002441 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002442 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002443 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002444 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2445 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2446 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2447 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2448 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002449 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002450
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002451 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2452 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2453 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2454
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002455 Example :
2456 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2457 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2458 # connections.
2459 backend dynamic
2460 fullconn 10000
2461 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2462 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2463
2464 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2465
2466
2467grace <time>
2468 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002470 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002471 Arguments :
2472 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2473 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2474 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2475
2476 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2477 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002478 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002479 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2480
2481 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2482 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2483 simplify it.
2484
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002485
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002486hash-type <method>
2487 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2489 yes | no | yes | yes
2490 Arguments :
2491 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2492 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2493 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2494 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2495 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2496 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2497 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2498 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2499 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2500
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002501 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2502 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2503 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2504 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2505 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2506 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2507 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2508 this value.
2509
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002510 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2511 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2512 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2513 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2514 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2515 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2516 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2517 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2518 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2519 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2520 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2521 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2522 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2523
2524 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2525
2526 See also : "balance", "server"
2527
2528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529http-check disable-on-404
2530 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002532 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 Arguments : none
2534
2535 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2536 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2537 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2538 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2539 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2540 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2541 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2542 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002543 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2544 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2545 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2546
2547 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2548
2549
2550http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002551 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002553 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002554 Arguments :
2555 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2556 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002557 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002558 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2559 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2560 details on the supported keywords.
2561
2562 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2563 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2564 with the usual backslash ('\').
2565
2566 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2567 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2568 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2569 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2570 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2571
2572 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002573 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002574 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2575 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2576 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2577
2578 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002579 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002580 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2581 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2582 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2583 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2584
2585 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002586 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002587 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2588 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2589 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2590 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2591 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2592 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2593 trace).
2594
2595 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002596 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002597 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2598 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2599 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2600 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2601 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2602 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2603
2604 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2605 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2606 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2607 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2608 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2609 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2610 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2611 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2612
2613 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2614 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2615
2616 Examples :
2617 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002618 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002619
2620 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002621 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002622
2623 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002624 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002625
2626 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002627 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002629 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002630
2631
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002632http-check send-state
2633 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2635 yes | no | yes | yes
2636 Arguments : none
2637
2638 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2639 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2640 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2641 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2642 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2643
2644 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2645 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2646 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2647 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2648 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2649 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2650 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2651 checked in multiple backends.
2652
2653 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2654 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2655
2656 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2657 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2658 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2659 one fails.
2660
2661 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2662 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2663 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2664
2665 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2666 server's queue.
2667
2668 Example of a header received by the application server :
2669 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2670 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2671
2672 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2673
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002674http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002675 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002676 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2677 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002678 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002679 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2680
2681 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2682 no | yes | yes | yes
2683
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002684 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2685 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2686 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2687 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2688 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002689
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002690 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2691 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2692 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2693
2694 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2695 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2696 are evaluated.
2697
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002698 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2699 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2700 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2701 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2702 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2703 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2704 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2705 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2706 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2707 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2708 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2709
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002710 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2711 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2712 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2713 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2714 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2715
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002716 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2717 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2718 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
2719 "http-request" rules. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
2720
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002721 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2722 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2723 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2724 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2725 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2726 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2727 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2728 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2729
2730 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2731 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2732 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2733 external users.
2734
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002735 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2736 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2737 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2738 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2739 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2740 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2741 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2742 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2743
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002744 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2745 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2746 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2747 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2748 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2749 another equipment.
2750
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002751 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2752 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2753 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2754 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2755 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2756 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2757 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2758 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2759
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002760 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2761 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2762 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2763 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2764 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2765 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2766 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2767 admin privileges.
2768
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002769 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2770
2771 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2772 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2773 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2774 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002775
2776 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002777 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2778 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2779 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002780
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002781 http-request allow if nagios
2782 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2783 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2784 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002785
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002786 Example:
2787 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002788 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002789
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002790 Example:
2791 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2792 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2793 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2794 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2795 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2796 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2797 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2798 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2799 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2800
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002801 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2802 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002803
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002804http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002805 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002806 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2807 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002808 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2809
2810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2811 no | yes | yes | yes
2812
2813 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2814 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2815 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2816 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2817 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2818 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2819
2820 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2821 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2822 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2823 current section.
2824
2825 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2826 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2827 rules are evaluated.
2828
2829 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2830 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2831 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2832 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2833 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2834 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2835 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2836
2837 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2838 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2839 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2840 external users.
2841
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002842 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2843 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2844 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2845 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2846 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2847 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2848 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2849 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2850
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002851 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2852 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2853 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2854 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2855 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2856 another equipment.
2857
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002858 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2859 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2860 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2861 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2862 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2863 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2864 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2865 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2866
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002867 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2868 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2869 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2870 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2871 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2872 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2873 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2874 admin privileges.
2875
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002876 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2877
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002878 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002879 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2880 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2881 rules.
2882
2883 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2884 ACL usage.
2885
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002886http-send-name-header [<header>]
2887 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2888
2889 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2890 yes | no | yes | yes
2891
2892 Arguments :
2893
2894 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2895
2896 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2897 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2898 is added with the header string proved.
2899
2900 See also : "server"
2901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002902id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002903 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2905 no | yes | yes | yes
2906 Arguments : none
2907
2908 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2909 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2910 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002911
2912
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002913ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2914 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2915 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2916 no | yes | yes | yes
2917
2918 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2919 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2920 and running).
2921
2922 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2923 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2924 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2925 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2926 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2927
2928 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2929 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2930
2931 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2932 "unless" condition is met.
2933
2934 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2935
2936
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002937log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002938log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002939no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002940 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2942 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002943
2944 Prefix :
2945 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2946 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2947 prefix does not allow arguments.
2948
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002949 Arguments :
2950 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2951 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2952 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2953 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2954 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2955 parameter.
2956
2957 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2958 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2959
2960 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2961 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2962 standard syslog port).
2963
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002964 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2965 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2966 standard syslog port).
2967
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002968 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2969 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2970 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2971 appropriately writeable).
2972
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002973 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
2974 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
2975 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
2976 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
2977
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002978 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2979
2980 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2981 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2982 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2983
2984 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2985 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2986 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002987 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2988 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2989 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2990 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2991 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002992
2993 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2994
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002995 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2996 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2997 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002998
2999 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3000 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3001 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3002 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3003
3004 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3005 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003006
3007 Example :
3008 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003009 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3010 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003011 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3012
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003013
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003014log-format <string>
3015 Allows you to custom a log line.
3016
3017 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3018
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003019
3020maxconn <conns>
3021 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3023 yes | yes | yes | no
3024 Arguments :
3025 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3026 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3027 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3028 closes.
3029
3030 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3031 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3032 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3033 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3034 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3035 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3036 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3037 properly tuned.
3038
3039 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3040 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3041 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3042
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003043 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3044
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003045 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3046
3047
3048mode { tcp|http|health }
3049 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3051 yes | yes | yes | yes
3052 Arguments :
3053 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3054 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3055 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3056 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3057
3058 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3059 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3060 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3061 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3062 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3063
3064 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003065 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3066 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3067 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3068 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3069 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3070 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3071 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003072
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003073 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3074 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3075 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003076
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003077 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003078 defaults http_instances
3079 mode http
3080
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003081 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003082
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003084monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003085 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3087 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003088 Arguments :
3089 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3090 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003091 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3093 backend and its backup.
3094
3095 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3096 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3097 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3098 servers in a list of backends.
3099
3100 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3101 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3102 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3103 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3104 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3105 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3106 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003107 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3108 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003109
3110 Example:
3111 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003112 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003113 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3114 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3115 monitor-uri /site_alive
3116 monitor fail if site_dead
3117
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003118 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003119
3120
3121monitor-net <source>
3122 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 yes | yes | yes | no
3125 Arguments :
3126 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3127 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3128 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3129 followed by a mask.
3130
3131 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3132 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003133 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003134 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3135
3136 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3137 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3138 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3139 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003140 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3141 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3142 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003143
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003144 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3145 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3146 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3147 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3148 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3149 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003150
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003151 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3152 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003153
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003154 Example :
3155 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3156 frontend www
3157 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3158
3159 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3160
3161
3162monitor-uri <uri>
3163 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3165 yes | yes | yes | no
3166 Arguments :
3167 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3168 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3169
3170 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3171 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3172 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3173 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3174 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3175 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3176 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3177 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3178
3179 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3180 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3181 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3182 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3183 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3184 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3185
3186 Example :
3187 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3188 frontend www
3189 mode http
3190 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3191
3192 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003194
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003195option abortonclose
3196no option abortonclose
3197 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3199 yes | no | yes | yes
3200 Arguments : none
3201
3202 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3203 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3204 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3205 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003206 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003207 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3208 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3209 encountered while delivering the response.
3210
3211 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3212 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3213 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3214 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3215 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3216 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003217 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003218 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003219 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003220 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3221 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3222 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3223
3224 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3225 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3226 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3227 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3228 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3229 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3230 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3231 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003232 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003233
3234 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3235 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3236
3237 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3238
3239
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003240option accept-invalid-http-request
3241no option accept-invalid-http-request
3242 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | no
3245 Arguments : none
3246
3247 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3248 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3249 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3250 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3251 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3252 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3253 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3254 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003255 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3256 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3257 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3258 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3259 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3260 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003261
3262 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3263 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3264 been confirmed.
3265
3266 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3267 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003268 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3269 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003270 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3271
3272 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3273 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3274
3275 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3276 stats socket.
3277
3278
3279option accept-invalid-http-response
3280no option accept-invalid-http-response
3281 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3283 yes | no | yes | yes
3284 Arguments : none
3285
3286 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3287 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3288 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3289 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3290 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3291 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3292 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3293 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3294 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3295
3296 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3297 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3298 been confirmed.
3299
3300 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3301 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3302 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3303 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3304
3305 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3306 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3307
3308 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3309 stats socket.
3310
3311
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003312option allbackups
3313no option allbackups
3314 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3316 yes | no | yes | yes
3317 Arguments : none
3318
3319 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3320 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3321 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3322 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3323 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3324 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3325 order between the backup servers anymore.
3326
3327 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3328 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3329
3330 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3331 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3332
3333
3334option checkcache
3335no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003336 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3338 yes | no | yes | yes
3339 Arguments : none
3340
3341 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3342 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003343 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003344 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3345 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003346 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003347
3348 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003349 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003350 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003351 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3352 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003353 to the client are :
3354 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003355 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003356 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003357 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3358 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3359 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3360 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3361 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3362 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3363 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3364 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3365 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3366 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3367 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3368
3369 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003370 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003371 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003372 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003373 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3374
3375 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3376 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003377 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003378 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3379
3380 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3381 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3382
3383
3384option clitcpka
3385no option clitcpka
3386 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3388 yes | yes | yes | no
3389 Arguments : none
3390
3391 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3392 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3393 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3394 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3395
3396 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3397 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3398 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3399 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3400
3401 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3402 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3403 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3404 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3405 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3406
3407 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3408
3409 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3410 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3411 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3412
3413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3415
3416 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3417
3418
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419option contstats
3420 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3422 yes | yes | yes | no
3423 Arguments : none
3424
3425 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3426 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3427 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3428 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3429 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3430 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3431 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3432
3433
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003434option dontlog-normal
3435no option dontlog-normal
3436 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3438 yes | yes | yes | no
3439 Arguments : none
3440
3441 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3442 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3443 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3444 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3445 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3446 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3447 logged.
3448
3449 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3450 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3451 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003453 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003454 logging.
3455
3456
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003457option dontlognull
3458no option dontlognull
3459 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3461 yes | yes | yes | no
3462 Arguments : none
3463
3464 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3465 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3466 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3467 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3468 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3469 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3470 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3471
3472 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3473 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3474 would not be logged.
3475
3476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003479 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003480
3481
3482option forceclose
3483no option forceclose
3484 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003486 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003487 Arguments : none
3488
3489 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3490 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3491 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3492 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3493 global session times in the logs.
3494
3495 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003496 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003497 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3498 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3499 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3500 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003501
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003502 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3503 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3504 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3505
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3508
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003509 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003510
3511
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003512option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003513 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3515 yes | yes | yes | yes
3516 Arguments :
3517 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3518 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003519 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003520 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003521
3522 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3523 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3524 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3525 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3526 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3527 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3528 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003529 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3530 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3531 possible that the client has already brought one.
3532
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003533 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003534 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003535 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3536 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003537 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3538 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003539
3540 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3541 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3542 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3543 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3544 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3545 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3546 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3547
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003548 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3549 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3550 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3551 are under the control of the end-user.
3552
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003553 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003554 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3555 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003556 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3557 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3558 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003559
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003560 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3561 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3562 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3563 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3564 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003565
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003566 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003567 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3568 frontend www
3569 mode http
3570 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3571
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003572 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3573 backend www
3574 mode http
3575 option forwardfor header X-Client
3576
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003577 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3578 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003579
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003580
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003581option http-no-delay
3582no option http-no-delay
3583 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 yes | yes | yes | yes
3586 Arguments : none
3587
3588 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3589 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3590 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3591 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3592 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3593 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3594 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3595 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3596 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3597 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3598 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3599 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3600 affected.
3601
3602 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3603 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3604 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3605 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3606 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3607 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3608 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3609 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3610 latency environments.
3611
3612
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003613option http-pretend-keepalive
3614no option http-pretend-keepalive
3615 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 yes | yes | yes | yes
3618 Arguments : none
3619
3620 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3621 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3622 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3623 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3624 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3625 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3626 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3627 consider the response complete.
3628
3629 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3630 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3631 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3632 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3633 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3634 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3635
3636 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3637 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3638 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3639 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3640 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3641 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3642 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3643
3644 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3645 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003646 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003647 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3648 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003649
3650 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3651 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3652
3653 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3654
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003655
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003656option http-server-close
3657no option http-server-close
3658 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3660 yes | yes | yes | yes
3661 Arguments : none
3662
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003663 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3664 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3665 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3666 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3667 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3668 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3669 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3670 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3671 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3672 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3673 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3674 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003675
3676 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3677 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3678 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3679 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003680 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3681 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003682
3683 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3684 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003685 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3686 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3687 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003688
3689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3691
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003692 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3693 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003694
3695
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003696option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003697no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003698 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3700 yes | yes | yes | no
3701 Arguments : none
3702
3703 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3704 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3705 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3706 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3707 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3708 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3709 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3710
3711 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3712 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3713 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3714 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3715 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3716 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3717 request along its whole life.
3718
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003719 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3720 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3721 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3722 front of an existing proxy.
3723
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003724 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3725
3726 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3727 http-server-close".
3728
3729
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003730option httpchk
3731option httpchk <uri>
3732option httpchk <method> <uri>
3733option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3734 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3736 yes | no | yes | yes
3737 Arguments :
3738 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3739 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3740 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3741 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3742 ones.
3743
3744 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3745 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3746 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3747
3748 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3749 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3750 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3751 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3752 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3753
3754 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3755 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3756 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3757 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3758 the lack of any response.
3759
3760 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3761
3762 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3763 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3764 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3765
3766 Examples :
3767 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3768 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3769 backend https_relay
3770 mode tcp
3771 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3772 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3773
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003774 See also : "option lb-agent-chk", "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk",
3775 "option mysql-check", "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and
3776 the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003777
3778
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003779option httpclose
3780no option httpclose
3781 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3783 yes | yes | yes | yes
3784 Arguments : none
3785
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003786 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3787 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3788 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3789 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3790 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3791 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3792 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003793
3794 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003795 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003796 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3797 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3798 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3799 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3800 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003801
3802 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3803 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3804 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003805 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3806 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003807
3808 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3809 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3810
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003811 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3812 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003813
3814
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003815option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003816 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3818 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003819 Arguments :
3820 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3821 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3822 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3823 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3824 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003825
3826 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3827 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3828 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3829 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3830 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3831 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3832 ports.
3833
3834 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3835
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3838 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3839 by default.
3840
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003841 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003842
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003843
3844option http_proxy
3845no option http_proxy
3846 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3848 yes | yes | yes | yes
3849 Arguments : none
3850
3851 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3852 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3853 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3854 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3855 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3856
3857 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3858 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3859 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3860 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003861 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003862 be analyzed.
3863
3864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3866
3867 Example :
3868 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3869 backend direct_forward
3870 option httpclose
3871 option http_proxy
3872
3873 See also : "option httpclose"
3874
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003875
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003876option independent-streams
3877no option independent-streams
3878 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3880 yes | yes | yes | yes
3881 Arguments : none
3882
3883 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3884 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3885 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3886 receive data or not.
3887
3888 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3889 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3890 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3891 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3892 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3893 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3894 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3895 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3896 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3897 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3898 socket buffers.
3899
3900 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3901 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3902 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3903 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3904 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3905
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003906 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3907 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3908 deprecated.
3909
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003910 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003911
3912
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09003913option lb-agent-chk
3914 Use a TCP connection to obtain a metric of server health
3915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3916 yes | no | yes | yes
3917 Arguments : none
3918
3919 This alters health checking behaviour by connecting making a TCP
3920 connection and reading an ASCII string. The string should have one of
3921 the following forms:
3922
3923 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
3924 e.g. "75%"
3925
3926 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
3927 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
3928
3929 * The string "drain".
3930
3931 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
3932 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
3933 persistence.
3934
3935 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
3936
3937 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
3938
3939 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
3940
3941 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3942
3943 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
3944
3945 This currently has the same behaviour as down (iii).
3946
3947 The use of an alternate check-port, used to obtain agent heath check
3948 information described above as opposed to the port of the service, may be
3949 useful in conjunction with this option.
3950
3951
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003952option ldap-check
3953 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3955 yes | no | yes | yes
3956 Arguments : none
3957
3958 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3959 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3960 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3961 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3962
3963 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3964 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3965
3966 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3967 configure it.
3968
3969 Example :
3970 option ldap-check
3971
3972 See also : "option httpchk"
3973
3974
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003975option log-health-checks
3976no option log-health-checks
3977 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3979 yes | no | yes | yes
3980 Arguments : none
3981
3982 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3983 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3984 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3985 of additional information is limited.
3986
3987 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3988 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3989
3990 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3991
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003992
3993option log-separate-errors
3994no option log-separate-errors
3995 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3997 yes | yes | yes | no
3998 Arguments : none
3999
4000 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4001 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4002 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4003 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4004 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4005 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4006 provides very important information.
4007
4008 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4009 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4010 error logs.
4011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004012 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004013 logging.
4014
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004015
4016option logasap
4017no option logasap
4018 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4020 yes | yes | yes | no
4021 Arguments : none
4022
4023 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4024 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4025 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4026 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4027 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4028 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4029 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004030 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004031 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4032 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4033
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004034 Examples :
4035 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4036 mode http
4037 option httplog
4038 option logasap
4039 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4040
4041 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4042 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4043 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4044 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004046 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004047 logging.
4048
4049
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004050option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4051 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4053 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004054 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004055 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4056 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004057
4058 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4059 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4060 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4061 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4062 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4063 in the MySQL table, like this :
4064
4065 USE mysql;
4066 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4067 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4068
4069 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4070 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4071 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4072 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4073 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4074 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4075 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4076 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4077 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4078
4079 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4080 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004081
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004082 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004083
4084 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4085 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4086 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4087 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4088 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4089 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4090
4091 See also: "option httpchk"
4092
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004093option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4094 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4096 yes | no | yes | yes
4097 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004098 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4099 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004100
4101 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4102 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4103 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4104 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4105
4106 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004107
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004108option nolinger
4109no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004110 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004111 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4112 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004113 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004114
4115 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4116 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4117 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4118 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4119 connections.
4120
4121 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4122 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4123 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4124 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4125 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4126 this too.
4127
4128 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4129 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4130 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4131
4132 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4133 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4134 for servers.
4135
4136 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4137 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4138
4139
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004140option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4141 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4143 yes | yes | yes | yes
4144 Arguments :
4145 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4146 matching <network>
4147 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4148 header name.
4149
4150 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4151 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4152 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4153 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4154 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4155 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4156 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4157 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4158 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4159 possible that the client has already brought one.
4160
4161 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4162 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4163 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4164 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4165 header and requires different one.
4166
4167 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4168 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4169 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4170 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4171 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4172 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4173 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4174
4175 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4176 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4177 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4178 both are defined.
4179
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004180 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4181 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4182 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4183 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4184 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004185
4186 Examples :
4187 # Original Destination address
4188 frontend www
4189 mode http
4190 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4191
4192 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4193 backend www
4194 mode http
4195 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4196
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004197 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4198 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004199
4200
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004201option persist
4202no option persist
4203 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4205 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004206 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004207
4208 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4209 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4210 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4211 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4212 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4213 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4214 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4215 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4216 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4217 redirected to another valid server.
4218
4219 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4220 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4221
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004222 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004223
4224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004225option redispatch
4226no option redispatch
4227 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4228 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4229 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004230 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004231
4232 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4233 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4234 be able to access the service anymore.
4235
4236 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4237 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4238
4239 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4240 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4241 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004242
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004243 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4244 "redisp" keywords.
4245
4246 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4247 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4248
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004249 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004250
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004251
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004252option redis-check
4253 Use redis health checks for server testing
4254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4255 yes | no | yes | yes
4256 Arguments : none
4257
4258 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4259 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4260 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4261 find the "+PONG" response message.
4262
4263 Example :
4264 option redis-check
4265
4266 See also : "option httpchk"
4267
4268
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004269option smtpchk
4270option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4271 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4273 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004274 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004275 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4276 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4277 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4278
4279 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4280 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4281 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4282
4283 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4284 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4285 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4286 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4287 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4288 dead server.
4289
4290 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4291 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4292 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4293 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4294
4295 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4296 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4297 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4298 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4299 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4300
4301 Example :
4302 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4303
4304 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004307option socket-stats
4308no option socket-stats
4309
4310 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4312 yes | yes | yes | no
4313
4314 Arguments : none
4315
4316
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004317option splice-auto
4318no option splice-auto
4319 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4321 yes | yes | yes | yes
4322 Arguments : none
4323
4324 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4325 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4326 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4327 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004328 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004329 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4330 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4331 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4332 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4333
4334 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4335 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4336 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4337 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4338 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4339 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4340 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4341 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4342 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4343 keyword.
4344
4345 Example :
4346 option splice-auto
4347
4348 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4349 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4350
4351 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4352 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4353
4354
4355option splice-request
4356no option splice-request
4357 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4359 yes | yes | yes | yes
4360 Arguments : none
4361
4362 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004363 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004364 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4365 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4366 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4367 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4368
4369 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4370
4371 Example :
4372 option splice-request
4373
4374 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4375 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4376
4377 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4378 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4379
4380
4381option splice-response
4382no option splice-response
4383 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4385 yes | yes | yes | yes
4386 Arguments : none
4387
4388 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004389 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004390 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4391 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4392 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4393 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4394
4395 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4396
4397 Example :
4398 option splice-response
4399
4400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4402
4403 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4404 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4405
4406
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004407option srvtcpka
4408no option srvtcpka
4409 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | no | yes | yes
4412 Arguments : none
4413
4414 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4415 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4416 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4417 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4418
4419 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4420 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4421 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4422 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4423
4424 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4425 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4426 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4427 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4428 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4429
4430 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4431
4432 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4433 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4434 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4435
4436 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4437 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4438
4439 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4440
4441
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004442option ssl-hello-chk
4443 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4445 yes | no | yes | yes
4446 Arguments : none
4447
4448 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4449 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4450 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4451 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4452 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4453 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4454 hello message.
4455
4456 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4457 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4458 messages, which is appreciable.
4459
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004460 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4461 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4462 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004463
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004464 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4465
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004466
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004467option tcp-smart-accept
4468no option tcp-smart-accept
4469 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4471 yes | yes | yes | no
4472 Arguments : none
4473
4474 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4475 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4476 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4477 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4478 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4479 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4480
4481 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4482 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4483 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4484 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4485
4486 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4487 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4488 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4489 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4490
4491 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4492 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4493 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4494
4495 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4496 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4497 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4498
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004499 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4500
4501
4502option tcp-smart-connect
4503no option tcp-smart-connect
4504 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4506 yes | no | yes | yes
4507 Arguments : none
4508
4509 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4510 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4511 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4512 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4513 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4514
4515 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4516 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4517 complex.
4518
4519 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4520 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4521 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4522
4523 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4524 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4525
4526 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4527
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004528
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004529option tcpka
4530 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4532 yes | yes | yes | yes
4533 Arguments : none
4534
4535 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4536 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4537 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4538 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4539
4540 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4541 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4542 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4543 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4544
4545 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4546 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4547 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4548 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4549 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4550
4551 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4552
4553 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4554 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4555 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4556 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4557 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4558 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4559 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4560 backends.
4561
4562 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4563
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004564
4565option tcplog
4566 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4568 yes | yes | yes | yes
4569 Arguments : none
4570
4571 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4572 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4573 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4574 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4575 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4576 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4577 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4578 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4579
4580 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004582 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004583
4584
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004585option transparent
4586no option transparent
4587 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004589 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004590 Arguments : none
4591
4592 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4593 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4594 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4595 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4596 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4597 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4598 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4599 appropriate server.
4600
4601 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4602 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4603
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004604 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004605 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004606
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004607
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004608persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004609persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004610 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4612 yes | no | yes | yes
4613 Arguments :
4614 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004615 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4616 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004617
4618 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4619 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4620 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4621 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4622 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4623 forwarded to this server.
4624
4625 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4626 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4627 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004628 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004629 a single "listen" section.
4630
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004631 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4632 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4633 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4634
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004635 Example :
4636 listen tse-farm
4637 bind :3389
4638 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4639 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4640 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4641 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4642 persist rdp-cookie
4643 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004644 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004645 balance rdp-cookie
4646 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4647 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4648
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004649 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4650 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004651
4652
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004653rate-limit sessions <rate>
4654 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4656 yes | yes | yes | no
4657 Arguments :
4658 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4659 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4660
4661 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4662 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4663 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4664 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4665 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4666 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4667
4668 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4669 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4670 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4671 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4672
4673 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4674 listen smtp
4675 mode tcp
4676 bind :25
4677 rate-limit sessions 10
4678 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4679
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004680 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4681 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4682 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004683
4684 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4685
4686
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004687redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4688redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4689redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004690 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4692 no | yes | yes | yes
4693
4694 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004695 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004696
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004697 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004698 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4699 the HTTP "Location" header.
4700
4701 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4702 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4703 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4704 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4705 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4706 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4707
4708 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4709 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4710 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4711 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4712 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4713 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4714 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4715 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4716 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004717
4718 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01004719 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
4720 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
4721 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
4722 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
4723 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
4724 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
4725 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
4726 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004727
4728 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4729 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4730
4731 - "drop-query"
4732 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4733 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4734 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4735 with a location-type redirect.
4736
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004737 - "append-slash"
4738 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4739 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4740 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4741 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4742
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004743 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4744 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4745 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4746 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4747 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4748 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4749 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4750
4751 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4752 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4753 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4754 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4755 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4756 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4757 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004758
4759 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4760 acl clear dst_port 80
4761 acl secure dst_port 8080
4762 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004763 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004764 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004765 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4766
4767 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004768 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4769 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4770 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004771 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004772
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004773 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4774 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4775 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4776
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004777 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004778 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004780 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004781
4782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004783redisp (deprecated)
4784redispatch (deprecated)
4785 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004788 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004789
4790 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4791 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4792 be able to access the service anymore.
4793
4794 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4795 redistribute them to a working server.
4796
4797 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4798 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4799 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004801 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4802 "option redispatch" instead.
4803
4804 See also : "option redispatch"
4805
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004806
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004807reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004808 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4810 no | yes | yes | yes
4811 Arguments :
4812 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4813 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004814 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004815
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004816 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4817 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4818
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004819 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4820 the last header of an HTTP request.
4821
4822 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4823 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4824 responses.
4825
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004826 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4827 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4828 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4829
4830 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4831 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004832
4833
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004834reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4835reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004836 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4838 no | yes | yes | yes
4839 Arguments :
4840 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4841 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4842 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4843 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4844 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4845 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4846 ignores case.
4847
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004848 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4849 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4850
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004851 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4852 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4853 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4854 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004855 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004856
4857 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4858 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4859
4860 Example :
4861 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4862 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4863 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4864
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004865 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4866 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004867
4868
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004869reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4870reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004871 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4873 no | yes | yes | yes
4874 Arguments :
4875 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4876 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4877 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4878 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4879 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4880 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4881
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004882 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4883 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4884
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004885 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4886 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4887 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4888 next servers.
4889
4890 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4891 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4892 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4893
4894 Example :
4895 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4896 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4897 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4898
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004899 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4900 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004901
4902
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004903reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4904reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004905 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4907 no | yes | yes | yes
4908 Arguments :
4909 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4910 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4911 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4912 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4913 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4914 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4915 case.
4916
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004917 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4918 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4919
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004920 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4921 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4922 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4923 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004924 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004925
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004926 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004927 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004928 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004929
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004930 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4931 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4932
4933 Example :
4934 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4935 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4936 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4937
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004938 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4939 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004940
4941
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004942reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4943reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004944 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 no | yes | yes | yes
4947 Arguments :
4948 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4949 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4950 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4951 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4952 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4953 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4954 case.
4955
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004956 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4957 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4958
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004959 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4960 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4961 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4962 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4963
4964 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4965 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4966
4967 Example :
4968 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4969 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4970 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4971 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4972
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004973 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4974 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004975
4976
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004977reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4978reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004979 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4981 no | yes | yes | yes
4982 Arguments :
4983 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4984 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4985 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4986 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4987 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4988 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4989
4990 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4991 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4992 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4993 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004994 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004995
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004996 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4997 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4998
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004999 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5000 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5001 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5002
5003 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5004 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5005 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5006 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5007 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5008
5009 Example :
5010 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005011 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005012 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5013 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5014
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005015 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5016 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005017
5018
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005019reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5020reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005021 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 no | yes | yes | yes
5024 Arguments :
5025 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5026 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5027 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5028 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5029 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5030 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5031 ignores case.
5032
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005033 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5034 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5035
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005036 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5037 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005038 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5039 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5040 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005041 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5042 not set.
5043
5044 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5045 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5046 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5047 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5048 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5049
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005050 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005051 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5052 # block all others.
5053 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5054 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5055
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005056 # block bad guys
5057 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5058 reqitarpit . if badguys
5059
5060 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5061 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005062
5063
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005064retries <value>
5065 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5066 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5067 yes | no | yes | yes
5068 Arguments :
5069 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5070 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5071 default value is 3.
5072
5073 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5074 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5075 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5076
5077 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5078 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5079
5080 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5081 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5082
5083 See also : "option redispatch"
5084
5085
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005086rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005087 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5089 no | yes | yes | yes
5090 Arguments :
5091 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5092 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005094
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005095 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5096 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5097
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005098 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5099 the last header of an HTTP response.
5100
5101 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5102 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5103 responses.
5104
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005105 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5106 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005107
5108
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005109rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5110rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005111 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5113 no | yes | yes | yes
5114 Arguments :
5115 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5116 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5117 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5118 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5119 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5120 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5121 ignores case.
5122
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005123 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5124 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5125
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005126 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5127 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005128 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005129 client.
5130
5131 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5132 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5133 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5134
5135 Example :
5136 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005137 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005138
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005139 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5140 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005141
5142
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005143rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5144rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005145 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5147 no | yes | yes | yes
5148 Arguments :
5149 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5150 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5151 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5152 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5153 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5154 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5155 ignores case.
5156
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005157 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5158 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5159
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005160 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5161 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5162 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5163 case-sensitive.
5164
5165 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005166 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5167 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5168 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005169
5170 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5171 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5172
5173 Example :
5174 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5175 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5176
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005177 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5178 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005179
5180
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005181rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5182rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005183 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5185 no | yes | yes | yes
5186 Arguments :
5187 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5188 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5189 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5190 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5191 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5192 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5193 ignores case.
5194
5195 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5196 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5197 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5198 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005199 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005200
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005201 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5202 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5203
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005204 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5205 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5206 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5207
5208 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5209 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5210 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5211 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5212 are not case-sensitive.
5213
5214 Example :
5215 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5216 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5217
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005218 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5219 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005220
5221
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005222server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005223 Declare a server in a backend
5224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5225 no | no | yes | yes
5226 Arguments :
5227 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005228 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005229 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005230
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005231 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5232 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5233 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5234 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005235 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5236 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5237 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5238 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5239 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005240 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5241 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5242 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5243 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5244 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5245 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5246 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005247 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5248 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5249 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5250 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005251
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005252 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005253 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5254 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5255 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5256 adding this value to the client's port.
5257
5258 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5259 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005260 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005261
5262 Examples :
5263 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5264 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005265 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005266 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5267 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5268 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005269
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005270 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5271 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005272
5273
5274source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005275source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005276source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005277 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5279 yes | no | yes | yes
5280 Arguments :
5281 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5282 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005283
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005284 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005285 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5286 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5287 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5288 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5289 supported prefixes are :
5290 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5291 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5292 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005293 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5294 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5295 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5296 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005297
5298 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5299 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005300 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5301 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5302 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005303
5304 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5305 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5306 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5307 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5308 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5309 <addr>.
5310
5311 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5312 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5313 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5314 port.
5315
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005316 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5317 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5318 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5319 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005320 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005321 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5322 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5323 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5324 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5325 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5326 HTTP header.
5327
5328 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5329 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005330 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005331 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5332 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5333 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5334 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5335 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5336 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5337 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5338
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005339 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5340 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5341 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5342 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5343 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5344 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5345
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005346 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5347 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5348 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5349 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5350
5351 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5352 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5353 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5354 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5355 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5356 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5357
5358 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5359 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5360 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5361 there are two methods :
5362
5363 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5364 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5365 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5366 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5367 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5368 of the client ranges may be used.
5369
5370 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5371 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5372 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5373 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5374 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5375 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5376 same session.
5377
5378 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5379 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5380 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5381 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5382 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5383 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5384
5385 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5386 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5387 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005388 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005389
5390 Examples :
5391 backend private
5392 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5393 source 192.168.1.200
5394
5395 backend transparent_ssl1
5396 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5397 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5398
5399 backend transparent_ssl2
5400 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5401 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5402 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5403
5404 backend transparent_ssl3
5405 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5406 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5407 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5408
5409 backend transparent_smtp
5410 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5411 # with Tproxy version 4.
5412 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5413
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005414 backend transparent_http
5415 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5416 # proxy.
5417 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005419 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005420 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005422
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005423srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5424 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5426 yes | no | yes | yes
5427 Arguments :
5428 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5430 as explained at the top of this document.
5431
5432 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5433 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5434 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5435 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5436 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5437 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5438 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5439
5440 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5441 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5442 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5443 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5444 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005445 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005446 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005447 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005448
5449 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5450 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5451 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5452 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5453 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5454 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5455
5456 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5457 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5458
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005459 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5460 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005461
5462
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005463stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5464 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5466 no | no | yes | yes
5467
5468 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5469 matched.
5470
5471 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5472 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5473
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005474 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5475 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5476 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5477
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005478 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5479 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5480 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5481 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005482
5483 Example :
5484 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5485 backend stats_localhost
5486 stats enable
5487 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5488
5489 Example :
5490 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5491 backend stats_auth
5492 stats enable
5493 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5494 stats admin if TRUE
5495
5496 Example :
5497 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5498 userlist stats-auth
5499 group admin users admin
5500 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5501 group readonly users haproxy
5502 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5503
5504 backend stats_auth
5505 stats enable
5506 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5507 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5508 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5509 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5510
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005511 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5512 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5513 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005514
5515
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005516stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5517 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5519 yes | no | yes | yes
5520 Arguments :
5521 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5522
5523 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5524
5525 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5526 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5527 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5528 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5529 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5530 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5531
5532 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5533 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5534 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005535 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005536
5537 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5538 report using "stats scope".
5539
5540 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5541 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5542 unobvious parameters.
5543
5544 Example :
5545 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5546 backend public_www
5547 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5548 stats enable
5549 stats hide-version
5550 stats scope .
5551 stats uri /admin?stats
5552 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5553 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5554 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5555
5556 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5557 backend private_monitoring
5558 stats enable
5559 stats uri /admin?stats
5560 stats refresh 5s
5561
5562 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5563
5564
5565stats enable
5566 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5568 yes | no | yes | yes
5569 Arguments : none
5570
5571 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5572 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5573 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5574 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5575 - stats auth : no authentication
5576 - stats scope : no restriction
5577
5578 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5579 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5580 unobvious parameters.
5581
5582 Example :
5583 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5584 backend public_www
5585 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5586 stats enable
5587 stats hide-version
5588 stats scope .
5589 stats uri /admin?stats
5590 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5591 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5592 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5593
5594 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5595 backend private_monitoring
5596 stats enable
5597 stats uri /admin?stats
5598 stats refresh 5s
5599
5600 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5601
5602
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005603stats hide-version
5604 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5606 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005607 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005608
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005609 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5610 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5611 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5612 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5613 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5614 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005616 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5617 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5618 unobvious parameters.
5619
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005620 Example :
5621 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5622 backend public_www
5623 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005624 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005625 stats hide-version
5626 stats scope .
5627 stats uri /admin?stats
5628 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5629 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5630 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005631
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005632 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5633 backend private_monitoring
5634 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005635 stats uri /admin?stats
5636 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005637
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005638 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005639
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005640
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005641stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5642 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5643 Access control for statistics
5644
5645 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5646 no | no | yes | yes
5647
5648 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5649 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5650 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5651 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5652 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5653 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5654
5655 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5656 instance.
5657
5658 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5659 about ACL usage.
5660
5661
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005662stats realm <realm>
5663 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5665 yes | no | yes | yes
5666 Arguments :
5667 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5668 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5669 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5670
5671 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5672 using a backslash ('\').
5673
5674 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5675 only related to authentication.
5676
5677 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5678 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5679 unobvious parameters.
5680
5681 Example :
5682 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5683 backend public_www
5684 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5685 stats enable
5686 stats hide-version
5687 stats scope .
5688 stats uri /admin?stats
5689 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5690 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5691 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5692
5693 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5694 backend private_monitoring
5695 stats enable
5696 stats uri /admin?stats
5697 stats refresh 5s
5698
5699 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5700
5701
5702stats refresh <delay>
5703 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5705 yes | no | yes | yes
5706 Arguments :
5707 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5708 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5709 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5710 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5711 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5712 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5713
5714 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5715 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5716 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5717 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5718
5719 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5720 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5721 unobvious parameters.
5722
5723 Example :
5724 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5725 backend public_www
5726 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5727 stats enable
5728 stats hide-version
5729 stats scope .
5730 stats uri /admin?stats
5731 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5732 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5733 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5734
5735 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5736 backend private_monitoring
5737 stats enable
5738 stats uri /admin?stats
5739 stats refresh 5s
5740
5741 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5742
5743
5744stats scope { <name> | "." }
5745 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5747 yes | no | yes | yes
5748 Arguments :
5749 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5750 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5751 section in which the statement appears.
5752
5753 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5754 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5755 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5756 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5757 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5758 exists.
5759
5760 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5761 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5762 unobvious parameters.
5763
5764 Example :
5765 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5766 backend public_www
5767 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5768 stats enable
5769 stats hide-version
5770 stats scope .
5771 stats uri /admin?stats
5772 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5773 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5774 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5775
5776 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5777 backend private_monitoring
5778 stats enable
5779 stats uri /admin?stats
5780 stats refresh 5s
5781
5782 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5783
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005784
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005785stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005786 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | no | yes | yes
5789
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005790 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005791 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5792
5793 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5794 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5795
5796 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5797 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005798 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005799
5800 Example :
5801 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5802 backend private_monitoring
5803 stats enable
5804 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5805 stats uri /admin?stats
5806 stats refresh 5s
5807
5808 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5809 global section.
5810
5811
5812stats show-legends
5813 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5814 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5815 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5816 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5817 - IP (socket, server)
5818 - cookie (backend, server)
5819
5820 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5821 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005822 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005823
5824 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5825
5826
5827stats show-node [ <name> ]
5828 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5830 yes | no | yes | yes
5831 Arguments:
5832 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5833 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5834
5835 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5836 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005837 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005838
5839 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5840 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5841 unobvious parameters.
5842
5843 Example:
5844 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5845 backend private_monitoring
5846 stats enable
5847 stats show-node Europe-1
5848 stats uri /admin?stats
5849 stats refresh 5s
5850
5851 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5852 section.
5853
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005854
5855stats uri <prefix>
5856 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 yes | no | yes | yes
5859 Arguments :
5860 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5861 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5862 query string.
5863
5864 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5865 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5866 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5867 possible to reach it in the application.
5868
5869 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005870 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005871 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5872 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5873 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5874 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5875
5876 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5877 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5878 an address or a port to statistics only.
5879
5880 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5881 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5882 unobvious parameters.
5883
5884 Example :
5885 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5886 backend public_www
5887 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5888 stats enable
5889 stats hide-version
5890 stats scope .
5891 stats uri /admin?stats
5892 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5893 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5894 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5895
5896 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5897 backend private_monitoring
5898 stats enable
5899 stats uri /admin?stats
5900 stats refresh 5s
5901
5902 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5903
5904
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005905stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5906 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005908 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005909
5910 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02005911 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005912 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5913 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5914 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5915
5916 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5917 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5918 the "stick-table" statement.
5919
5920 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5921 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5922 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5923 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5924 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5925
5926 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5927 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5928 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5929 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5930 transformation rules.
5931
5932 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5933 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5934 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5935 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5936 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5937 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5938 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5939
5940 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5941 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5942 ACL based conditions.
5943
5944 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5945 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5946 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5947 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5948
5949 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5950 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5951 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5952 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5953
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005954 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5955 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5956 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5957
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005958 Example :
5959 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5960 # last 30 minutes
5961 backend pop
5962 mode tcp
5963 balance roundrobin
5964 stick store-request src
5965 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5966 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5967 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5968
5969 backend smtp
5970 mode tcp
5971 balance roundrobin
5972 stick match src table pop
5973 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5974 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5975
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005976 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5977 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005978
5979
5980stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5981 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5983 no | no | yes | yes
5984
5985 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5986 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5987 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5988 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5989
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005990 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5991 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5992 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5993
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005994 Examples :
5995 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005996 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005997
5998 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5999 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6000 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6001
6002
6003 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6004 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6005 backend http
6006 mode http
6007 balance roundrobin
6008 stick on src table https
6009 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6010 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6011 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6012
6013 backend https
6014 mode tcp
6015 balance roundrobin
6016 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6017 stick on src
6018 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6019 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6020
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006021 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006022
6023
6024stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6025 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6027 no | no | yes | yes
6028
6029 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006030 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006031 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6032 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6033 server is selected.
6034
6035 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6036 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6037 the "stick-table" statement.
6038
6039 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6040 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6041 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6042 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6043 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6044 address.
6045
6046 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6047 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6048 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6049 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6050 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6051 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6052 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6053 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6054 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6055 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6056
6057 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6058 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6059 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6060 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6061 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6062 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6063 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6064
6065 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6066 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6067 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6068 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6069
6070 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6071 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6072 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6073 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6074 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6075 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6076 another protocol or access method.
6077
6078 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6079 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6080 the request.
6081
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006082 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6083 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6084 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6085
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006086 Example :
6087 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6088 # last 30 minutes
6089 backend pop
6090 mode tcp
6091 balance roundrobin
6092 stick store-request src
6093 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6094 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6095 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6096
6097 backend smtp
6098 mode tcp
6099 balance roundrobin
6100 stick match src table pop
6101 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6102 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6103
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006104 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6105 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006106
6107
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006108stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006109 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6110 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006111 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
6112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006113 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006114
6115 Arguments :
6116 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6117 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6118 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6119 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6120
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006121 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6122 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6123 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6124 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6125
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006126 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6127 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6128 instance.
6129
6130 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6131 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6132 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6133 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6134 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6135 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006136 to 32 characters.
6137
6138 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6139 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6140 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6141 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6142 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6143 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006144
6145 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006146 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6147 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006148 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6149 increase.
6150
6151 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006152 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6153 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6154 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006155
6156 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6157 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6158 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6159 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6160 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6161 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6162 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6163 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6164 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6165 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6166 parameter (see below).
6167
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006168 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6169 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6170 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6171 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6172 soft restart.
6173
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006174 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6175
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006176 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6177 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6178 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6179 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6180 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006181 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006182 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6183 if not expiration delay is specified.
6184
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006185 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6186 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6187 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6188 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006189 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6190 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6191 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6192 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6193 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6194 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6195 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6196 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6197 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6198 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6199 types and their arguments.
6200
6201 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6202 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6203 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6204 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6205
6206 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6207 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6208 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6209 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6210
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006211 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6212 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6213 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6214 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6215 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6216 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6217
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006218 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6219 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6220 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6221 they were received.
6222
6223 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6224 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6225 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6226 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6227 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6228
6229 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6230 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6231 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6232 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6233 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6234
6235 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6236 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6237 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6238
6239 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6240 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6241 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6242 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6243 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6244
6245 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6246 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6247 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6248 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6249 the client side.
6250
6251 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6252 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6253 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6254 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6255 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6256 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6257 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6258
6259 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6260 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6261 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6262 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6263 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6264 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6265 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6266
6267 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6268 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6269 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6270 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6271 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6272 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6273
6274 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6275 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6276 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6277 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6278
6279 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6280 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6281 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6282 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6283 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6284 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6285 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6286 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6287 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6288 recommended for better fairness.
6289
6290 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6291 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6292 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6293 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6294
6295 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6296 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6297 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6298 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6299 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6300 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6301 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6302 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6303 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6304 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006305
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006306 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6307 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006308 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6309 reference it.
6310
6311 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6312 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6313 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6314 as an exclusive stickiness.
6315
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006316 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6317 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6318 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6319 something that can be ignored.
6320
6321 Example:
6322 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6323 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6324 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6325 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6326
6327 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006328 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006329
6330
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006331stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6332 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6334 no | no | yes | yes
6335
6336 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006337 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006338 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6339 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6340 server is selected.
6341
6342 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6343 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6344 the "stick-table" statement.
6345
6346 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6347 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6348 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6349 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6350
6351 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6352 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6353 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6354 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6355 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6356 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006357 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006358 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6359 rules.
6360
6361 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6362 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6363 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6364 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6365 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6366 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6367 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6368
6369 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6370 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6371 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6372 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6373
6374 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6375 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6376 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6377 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6378 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6379 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6380 another protocol or access method.
6381
6382 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6383
6384 Example :
6385 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6386 backend https
6387 mode tcp
6388 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006389 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006390 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006391
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006392 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6393 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6394
6395 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6396 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6397 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6398
6399 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6400 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006401
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006402 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6403 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6404 # at offset 44.
6405
6406 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6407 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6408
6409 # Learn on response if server hello.
6410 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006411
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006412 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6413 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6414
6415 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6416 extraction.
6417
6418
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006419tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6420 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6422 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006423 Arguments :
6424 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006425 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6426 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006427
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006428 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006429
6430 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6431 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006432 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6433 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6434 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6435 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6436 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6437 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006438
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006439 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6440 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6441 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6442 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006443
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006444 Three types of actions are supported :
6445 - accept :
6446 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6447 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6448 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006449
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006450 - reject :
6451 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6452 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6453 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6454 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6455 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6456 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6457 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6458 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6459 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6460 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6461 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6462 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006463
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006464 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6465 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6466 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6467 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6468 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6469 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6470 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6471 hosts.
6472
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006473 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006474 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6475 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6476 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006477 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6478 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006479 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006480 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6481 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6482 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6483 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6484 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006485
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006486 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006487 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006488 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006489 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6490 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6491 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6492 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006493
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006494 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6495 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6496 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6497 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006499 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6500 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6501 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6502 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6503 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006504 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6505 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6506 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6507 layer7 information is extracted.
6508
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006509 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6510 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6511 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6512 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6513 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006514
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006515 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6516 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6517 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006518
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006519 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6520 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6521 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006522
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006523 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006524 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006525 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006526
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006527 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6528 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6529 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006530
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006531 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006532 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6533 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006534
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006535 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6536
6537 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6538
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006539 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6540
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006541 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006542
6543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006544tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6545 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006547 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006548 Arguments :
6549 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006550 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6551 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006552 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006553
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006554 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006555
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006556 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6557 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6558 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6559 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6560 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006561
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006562 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6563 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6564 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6565 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6566 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6567 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6568 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6569 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6570 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006571
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006572 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6573 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6574 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6575 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006576
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006577 Three types of actions are supported :
6578 - accept :
6579 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006580 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006581
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006582 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6583 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006584
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006585 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6586 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6587 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006588 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6589 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6590 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6591 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006592 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6593 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006594 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006596 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006597 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6598 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006600 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006601 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6602 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6603 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6604 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6605 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006606
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006607 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6608 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6609 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6610 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6611
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006612 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006613 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6614 # and reject everything else.
6615 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6616 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006617 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006618 tcp-request content reject
6619
6620 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006621 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6622 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6623 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006624 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006625
6626 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6627 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6628 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006629 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006630 tcp-request content reject
6631
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006632 Example:
6633 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6634 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006635 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006636
6637 Example:
6638 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6639 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006640 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006641
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006642 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6643 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6644
6645 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006646 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006647 # protecting all our sites
6648 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006649 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6650 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006651 ...
6652 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6653
6654 backend http_dynamic
6655 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006656 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006657 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006658 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6659 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
6660 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006661 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006663 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006664
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006665 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006666
6667
6668tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6669 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006671 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006672 Arguments :
6673 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6674 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6675 as explained at the top of this document.
6676
6677 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6678 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6679 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6680 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6681 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6682
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006683 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6684 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6685 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6686 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6687
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006688 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6689 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006690 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006691 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006692 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6693 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6694 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6695 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006696
6697 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6698 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6699 it pass through unaffected.
6700
6701 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6702 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6703 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006704 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006705 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6706 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006707 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6708 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6709 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006710
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006711 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006712 "timeout client".
6713
6714
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006715tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6716 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6718 no | no | yes | yes
6719 Arguments :
6720 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006721 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006722
6723 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6724
6725 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6726 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6727 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006728 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
6729 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006730
6731 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6732
6733 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6734 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6735 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6736 inserted.
6737
6738 Two types of actions are supported :
6739 - accept :
6740 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6741 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6742 the rules evaluation.
6743
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006744 - close :
6745 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
6746 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
6747 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
6748 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
6749 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
6750 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
6751 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
6752 protocols.
6753
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006754 - reject :
6755 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6756 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006757 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006758
6759 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6760 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6761 for changing the default action to a reject.
6762
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006763 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6764 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6765 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6766 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006767 period.
6768
6769 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6770
6771 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6772
6773
6774tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6775 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6777 no | no | yes | yes
6778 Arguments :
6779 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6780 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6781 as explained at the top of this document.
6782
6783 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6784
6785
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006786timeout check <timeout>
6787 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6788 established.
6789
6790 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6791 yes | no | yes | yes
6792 Arguments:
6793 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6794 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6795 as explained at the top of this document.
6796
6797 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6798 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6799 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6800 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006801 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6802 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6803 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006804
6805 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6806 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6807
6808 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6809 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006810 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006811
6812 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6813 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6814 forget about it.
6815
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006816 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6817 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006818
6819
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006820timeout client <timeout>
6821timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6822 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6824 yes | yes | yes | no
6825 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006826 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006827 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6828 as explained at the top of this document.
6829
6830 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6831 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6832 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6833 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6834 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6835 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6836 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6837 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006838 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006839 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006840 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6841 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6842 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006843
6844 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6845 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6846 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6847 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6848 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6849 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6850
6851 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6852 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6853 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6854
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006855 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006856
6857
6858timeout connect <timeout>
6859timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6860 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6862 yes | no | yes | yes
6863 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006864 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6866 as explained at the top of this document.
6867
6868 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006869 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006870 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006871 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006872 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6873 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006874
6875 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6876 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6877 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6878 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6879 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6880 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6881
6882 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6883 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6884 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6885
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006886 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6887 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006888
6889
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006890timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6891 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6893 yes | yes | yes | yes
6894 Arguments :
6895 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6896 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6897 as explained at the top of this document.
6898
6899 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6900 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6901 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6902 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6903 once the request has started to present itself.
6904
6905 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6906 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6907 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6908 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6909 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6910
6911 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6912 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6913 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6914 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6915
6916 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6917 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6918 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6919 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6920 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006921 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006922
6923 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6924 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6925 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6926 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6927
6928 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6929
6930
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006931timeout http-request <timeout>
6932 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006934 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006935 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006936 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006937 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6938 as explained at the top of this document.
6939
6940 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6941 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6942 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6943 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6944 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6945 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6946 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6947 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6948
6949 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6950 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006951 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6952 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006953
6954 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6955 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6956 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6957 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6958 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6959
6960 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006961 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6962 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6963 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006964
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006965 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006966
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006967
6968timeout queue <timeout>
6969 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6971 yes | no | yes | yes
6972 Arguments :
6973 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6974 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6975 as explained at the top of this document.
6976
6977 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6978 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6979 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6980 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6981 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6982
6983 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6984 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6985 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6986 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6987
6988 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6989
6990
6991timeout server <timeout>
6992timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6993 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6995 yes | no | yes | yes
6996 Arguments :
6997 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6998 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6999 as explained at the top of this document.
7000
7001 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7002 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7003 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7004 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7005 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7006 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7007 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7008
7009 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7010 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7011 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7012 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7013 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007014 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007015 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007016 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7017 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7018 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7019 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007020
7021 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7022 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7023 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7024 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7025 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7026 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7027
7028 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7029 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7030 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7031
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007032 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007033
7034
7035timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007036 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7038 yes | yes | yes | yes
7039 Arguments :
7040 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7041 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7042 as explained at the top of this document.
7043
7044 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7045 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7046 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7047
7048 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7049 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7050 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7051 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007052 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007053
7054 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7055
7056
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007057timeout tunnel <timeout>
7058 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7060 yes | no | yes | yes
7061 Arguments :
7062 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7063 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7064 as explained at the top of this document.
7065
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007066 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007067 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7068 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7069 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7070 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7071 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7072 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7073 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7074 specified.
7075
7076 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7077 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7078 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7079 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7080 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7081
7082 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7083 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7084 forget about it.
7085
7086 Example :
7087 defaults http
7088 option http-server-close
7089 timeout connect 5s
7090 timeout client 30s
7091 timeout client 30s
7092 timeout server 30s
7093 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7094
7095 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7096
7097
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007098transparent (deprecated)
7099 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007101 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007102 Arguments : none
7103
7104 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7105 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7106 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7107 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7108 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7109 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7110 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7111 appropriate server.
7112
7113 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7114
7115 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7116 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7117
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007118 See also: "option transparent"
7119
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007120unique-id-format <string>
7121 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 yes | yes | yes | no
7124 Arguments :
7125 <string> is a log-format string.
7126
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007127 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7128 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7129 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7130 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007131
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007132 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7133 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7134 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7135 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7136 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7137 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7138 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7139 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007140
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007141 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7142 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007143
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007144 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007145
7146 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7147
7148 will generate:
7149
7150 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7151
7152 See also: "unique-id-header"
7153
7154unique-id-header <name>
7155 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7157 yes | yes | yes | no
7158 Arguments :
7159 <name> is the name of the header.
7160
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007161 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7162 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007163
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007164 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007165
7166 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7167 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7168
7169 will generate:
7170
7171 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7172
7173 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007174
7175use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7176use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007177 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7179 no | yes | yes | no
7180 Arguments :
7181 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007183 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007184
7185 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7186 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7187 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007188 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7189 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7190 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7191 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007192
7193 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7194 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7195 assign the backend.
7196
7197 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7198 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7199 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7200 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7201 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7202 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7203
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007204 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007205 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007206 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7207 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7208 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7209
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007210 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007211
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007212
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007213use-server <server> if <condition>
7214use-server <server> unless <condition>
7215 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7217 no | no | yes | yes
7218 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007219 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007220
7221 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7222
7223 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7224 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7225 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7226
7227 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7228 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7229 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7230 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7231 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7232 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7233 matches will assign the server.
7234
7235 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7236 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7237 with the next rules until one matches.
7238
7239 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7240 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7241 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7242 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7243
7244 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7245 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7246 stripped.
7247
7248 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7249 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7250 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7251 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7252
7253 Example :
7254 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7255 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7256 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7257 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7258 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7259 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7260 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7261 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7262 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7263
7264 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7265
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007266
72675. Bind and Server options
7268--------------------------
7269
7270The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7271depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7272settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7273written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7274described in this section.
7275
7276
72775.1. Bind options
7278-----------------
7279
7280The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7281as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7282no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7283parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7284while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7285provided immediately after the setting name.
7286
7287The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7288
7289accept-proxy
7290 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7291 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7292 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7293 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7294 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7295 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7296 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7297 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7298 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007299 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7300 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007301
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007302alpn <protocols>
7303 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7304 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7305 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7306 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7307 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7308 initial NPN extension.
7309
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007310backlog <backlog>
7311 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7312 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7313
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007314ecdhe <named curve>
7315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007316 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7317 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007318
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007319ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007320 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7321 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7322 client's certificate.
7323
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007324ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7326 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7327 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7328 error is ignored.
7329
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007330ciphers <ciphers>
7331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7332 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7333 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7334 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7335 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7336
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007337crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7339 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7340 to verify client's certificate.
7341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007342crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7344 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7345 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7346 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7347 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7348 file.
7349
7350 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7351 are loaded.
7352
7353 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7354 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7355 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7356 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7357 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7358 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7359 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7360 www.sub.example.org).
7361
7362 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7363 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7364 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7365 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7366 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7367
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007368 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007369
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007370 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7371 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7372 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7373 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7374 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7375 clients).
7376
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007377crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7379 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7380 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7381 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007382
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007383crt-list <file>
7384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007385 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7386 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007387
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007388 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007389
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007390 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7391 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7392 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7393 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7394 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7395 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7396 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7397 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007399defer-accept
7400 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7401 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7402 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7403 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7404 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7405 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7406 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7407 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7408 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7409 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7410 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7411
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007412force-sslv3
7413 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7414 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7415 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7416
7417force-tlsv10
7418 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7419 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7420
7421force-tlsv11
7422 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7423 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7424
7425force-tlsv12
7426 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7427 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7428
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007429gid <gid>
7430 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7431 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7432 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7433 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7434 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7435
7436group <group>
7437 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7438 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7439 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7440 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7441 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7442
7443id <id>
7444 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7445 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7446 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7447 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7448
7449interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007450 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7451 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7452 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7453 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7454 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7455 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7456 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007457
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007458level <level>
7459 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7460 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7461 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7462 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7463 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7464 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7465 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7466 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7467 counters).
7468 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7469 all counters).
7470
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007471maxconn <maxconn>
7472 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7473 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7474 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7475 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7476 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7477 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7478 eat all memory.
7479
7480mode <mode>
7481 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7482 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7483 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7484 UNIX sockets.
7485
7486mss <maxseg>
7487 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7488 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7489 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7490 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7491 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7492 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7493 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7494 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7495 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7496 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7497 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7498
7499name <name>
7500 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7501 page.
7502
7503nice <nice>
7504 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7505 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7506 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7507 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7508 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7509 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7510 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7511 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7512 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7513 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7514 one for an RDP socket.
7515
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007516no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7518 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7519 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007520 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7521 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007522
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007523no-tls-tickets
7524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7525 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7526 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7527 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7528
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007529no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007531 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7532 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7533 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7534 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007535
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007536no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007537 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007538 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7539 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7540 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7541 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007542
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007543no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007544 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007545 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7546 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7547 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7548 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007549
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007550npn <protocols>
7551 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7552 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7553 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7554 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007555 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7556 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007557
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007558ssl
7559 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7560 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7561 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7562 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7563 to deciphered contents.
7564
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007565strict-sni
7566 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7567 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7568 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7569 See the "crt" option for more information.
7570
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007571tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007572 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007573 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7574 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7575 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7576 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7577 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7578 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7579 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007580 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7581 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7582 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007583
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007584transparent
7585 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7586 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7587 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7588 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7589 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7590 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7591 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7592 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7593 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7594 so check for support with your vendor.
7595
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007596v4v6
7597 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7598 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7599 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7600 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7601 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7602
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007603v6only
7604 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7605 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7606 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007607 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7608 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007609
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007610uid <uid>
7611 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7612 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7613 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7614 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7615 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7616
7617user <user>
7618 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7619 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7620 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7621 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7622 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7623
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007624verify [none|optional|required]
7625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7626 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7627 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7628 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7629 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007630 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7631 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7632 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7633 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007634
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020076355.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007636------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007638The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7639which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7640arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7641settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7642after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7643Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7644address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007646 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007647 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007649The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007650
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007651addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007652 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7653 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7654 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7655 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7656 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007658 Supported in default-server: No
7659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007660backup
7661 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7662 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7663 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7664 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7665 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7666 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007668 Supported in default-server: No
7669
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007670ca-file <cafile>
7671 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7672 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7673 server's certificate.
7674
7675 Supported in default-server: No
7676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007677check
7678 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007679 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7680 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7681 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7682 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7683 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7684 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7685 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormana2b9dad2013-02-12 10:45:54 +09007686 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the
7687 "httpchk", "lb-agent-chk", "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and
7688 "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and parameters for
7689 more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007691 Supported in default-server: No
7692
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007693check-send-proxy
7694 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7695 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7696 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7697 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7698 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7699 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7700 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7701
7702 Supported in default-server: No
7703
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007704check-ssl
7705 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7706 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7707 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7708 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7709 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7710 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7711 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7712 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7713 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7714
7715 Supported in default-server: No
7716
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007717ciphers <ciphers>
7718 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7719 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7720 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7721 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7722 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7723 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7724 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7725 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7726
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007727 Supported in default-server: No
7728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007729cookie <value>
7730 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7731 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7732 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7733 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7734 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7735 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7736 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007738 Supported in default-server: No
7739
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007740crl-file <crlfile>
7741 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7742 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7743 to verify server's certificate.
7744
7745 Supported in default-server: No
7746
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007747crt <cert>
7748 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7749 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7750 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7751 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7752 certificate request.
7753
7754 Supported in default-server: No
7755
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007756disabled
7757 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7758 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7759 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7760 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7761 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7762
7763 Supported in default-server: No
7764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007765error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007766 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7767 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7768 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007770 Supported in default-server: Yes
7771
7772 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007774fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007775 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7776 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7777 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007779 Supported in default-server: Yes
7780
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007781force-sslv3
7782 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7783 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7784 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7785
7786 Supported in default-server: No
7787
7788force-tlsv10
7789 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7790 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7791
7792 Supported in default-server: No
7793
7794force-tlsv11
7795 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7796 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7797
7798 Supported in default-server: No
7799
7800force-tlsv12
7801 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7802 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7803
7804 Supported in default-server: No
7805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007806id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007807 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7808 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7809 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007810
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007811 Supported in default-server: No
7812
7813inter <delay>
7814fastinter <delay>
7815downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007816 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7817 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7818 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7819 between checks depending on the server state :
7820
7821 Server state | Interval used
7822 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7823 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7824 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7825 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7826 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7827 or yet unchecked. |
7828 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7829 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7830 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007832 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7833 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7834 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7835 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7836 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7837 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7838 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7839 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7840 servers.
7841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007842 Supported in default-server: Yes
7843
7844maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007845 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7846 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7847 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7848 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7849 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7850 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7851 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7852 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007854 Supported in default-server: Yes
7855
7856maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007857 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7858 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7859 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7860 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7861 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7862 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7863 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7864
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007865 Supported in default-server: Yes
7866
7867minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007868 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7869 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7870 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7871 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7872 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7873 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007874 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007875 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007877 Supported in default-server: Yes
7878
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007879no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007880 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7881 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007882 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007883
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007884 Supported in default-server: No
7885
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007886no-tls-tickets
7887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7888 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7889 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7890 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7891
7892 Supported in default-server: No
7893
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007894no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007895 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007896 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7897 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007898 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7899 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007900
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007901 Supported in default-server: No
7902
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007903no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007904 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007905 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7906 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007907 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7908 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007909
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007910 Supported in default-server: No
7911
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007912no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007913 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007914 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7915 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007916 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7917 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007918
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007919 Supported in default-server: No
7920
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007921non-stick
7922 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7923 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7924 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7925
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007926 Supported in default-server: No
7927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007928observe <mode>
7929 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7930 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7931 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7932 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7933 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7934 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007935 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007937 Supported in default-server: No
7938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007939 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007941on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007942 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7943 Currently, four modes are available:
7944 - fastinter: force fastinter
7945 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7946 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7947 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7948 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007950 Supported in default-server: Yes
7951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007952 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7953
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007954on-marked-down <action>
7955 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7956 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007957 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7958 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7959 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7960 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7961 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7962 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7963 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7964 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007965
7966 Actions are disabled by default
7967
7968 Supported in default-server: Yes
7969
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007970on-marked-up <action>
7971 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7972 Currently one action is available:
7973 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7974 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7975 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7976 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7977 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7978 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7979 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7980 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7981
7982 Actions are disabled by default
7983
7984 Supported in default-server: Yes
7985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007986port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007987 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7988 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7989 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7990 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7991 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7992 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007994 Supported in default-server: Yes
7995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007996redir <prefix>
7997 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7998 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7999 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8000 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8001 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8002 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8003 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8004 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008005 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008006 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8007 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8008 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8009 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8010 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8011
8012 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008014 Supported in default-server: No
8015
8016rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008017 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8018 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8019 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008021 Supported in default-server: Yes
8022
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008023send-proxy
8024 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8025 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8026 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8027 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8028 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8029 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8030 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8031 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8032 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008033 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8034 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8035 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8036 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8037 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008038
8039 Supported in default-server: No
8040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008041slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008042 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8043 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8044 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8045 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8046 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8047 parameters :
8048
8049 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8050 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8051
8052 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8053 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8054 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8055 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8056
8057 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8058 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8059 seen as failed.
8060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008061 Supported in default-server: Yes
8062
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008063source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008064source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008065source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008066 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8067 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8068 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8069 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8070
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008071 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8072 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8073 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8074 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8075 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8076 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8077 server.
8078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008079 Supported in default-server: No
8080
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008081ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008082 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8083 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8084 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8085 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8086 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8087 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8088 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008089
8090 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008092track [<proxy>/]<server>
8093 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8094 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8095 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8096 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8097 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008099 Supported in default-server: No
8100
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008101verify [none|required]
8102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8103 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8104 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8105 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008106 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8107 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8108 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008109
8110 Supported in default-server: No
8111
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008112verifyhost <hostname>
8113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8114 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8115 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8116 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8117 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8118 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8119
8120 Supported in default-server: No
8121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008122weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008123 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8124 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8125 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008126 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8127 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8128 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8129 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8130 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8131 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008132
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008133 Supported in default-server: Yes
8134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008135
81366. HTTP header manipulation
8137---------------------------
8138
8139In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8140response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8141request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8142which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8143against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8144to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8145passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8146headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8147never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8148
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008149There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8150(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8151rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8152messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8153in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008154happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008155add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8156normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008158This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8159in section 4.2 :
8160
8161 - reqadd <string>
8162 - reqallow <search>
8163 - reqiallow <search>
8164 - reqdel <search>
8165 - reqidel <search>
8166 - reqdeny <search>
8167 - reqideny <search>
8168 - reqpass <search>
8169 - reqipass <search>
8170 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8171 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8172 - reqtarpit <search>
8173 - reqitarpit <search>
8174 - rspadd <string>
8175 - rspdel <search>
8176 - rspidel <search>
8177 - rspdeny <search>
8178 - rspideny <search>
8179 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8180 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8181
8182With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8183is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8184parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8185prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8186Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8187
8188 \t for a tab
8189 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8190 \n for a new line (LF)
8191 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8192 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8193 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8194 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8195 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8196
8197The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8198portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8199above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8200regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
82019 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8202is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8203
8204The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8205after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8206
8207Notes related to these keywords :
8208---------------------------------
8209 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8210 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8211 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8212
8213 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8214 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8215 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8216
8217 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8218 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8219 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8220 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8221 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8222
8223 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8224 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8225 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8226 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8227 useless headers before adding new ones.
8228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008229 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008230 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8231
8232 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8233 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8234 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8235
8236 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8237 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008238 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008239
8240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020082417. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8242----------------------------------
8243
8244Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8245client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8246The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8247these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8248but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8249data called patterns.
8250
8251
82527.1. ACL basics
8253---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008254
8255The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8256content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8257from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8258simple :
8259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008260 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
8261 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8262 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008264The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8265adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008266
8267In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008269 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008270
8271This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8272Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8273and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
8274an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
8275of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
8276
8277ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8278'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8279which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8280
8281There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8282performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008284The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8285specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8286this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
8287methods of a same sample fetch method.
8288
8289Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8290 - boolean
8291 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8292 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8293 - string
8294 - data block
8295
8296The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8297 - boolean
8298 - integer or integer range
8299 - IP address / network
8300 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8301 - regular expression
8302 - hex block
8303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008304The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8305
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008306 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8307 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008308 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008309 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008311The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8312read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8313if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8314lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8315will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8316beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8317a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8318lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8319exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8320
8321Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8322loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8323
8324 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8325
8326In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8327the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8328case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8329as well.
8330
8331The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8332sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8333do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8334methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8335is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8336obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8337followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8338default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8339that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8340string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8341
8342There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8343sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8344be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008345
8346 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8347 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008348 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8349 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8350 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8351 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008352
8353 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8354 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008355 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008356
8357 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008358 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008359
8360 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008361 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008362
8363 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8364 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8365
8366 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8367 binary or string samples.
8368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008369 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8370 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008372 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8373 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8374 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008376 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8377 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008379 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8380 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008382 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8383 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008385 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8386 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008387 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008389 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8390 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8391 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008392
8393For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8394request, it is possible to do :
8395
8396 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8397
8398In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8399buffer, one would use the following acl :
8400
8401 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008403All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8404criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8405method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8406to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8407criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8408the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008410If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8411the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8412example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008414 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8415 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8416 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8417 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008418
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008420The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample fetch types
8421and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8422combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8423the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008425 +-------------------------------------------------+
8426 | Input sample type |
8427 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8428 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8429 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8430 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8431 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8432 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | | |
8433 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8434 | integer (value) | int | *int | | | |
8435 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8436 | integer (length) | | | | len | len |
8437 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8438 | IP address | | | *ip | | |
8439 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8440 | exact string | | | | str | str |
8441 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8442 | prefix | | | | beg | beg |
8443 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8444 | suffix | | | | end | end |
8445 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8446 | substring | | | | sub | sub |
8447 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8448 | subdir | | | | dir | dir |
8449 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8450 | domain | | | | dom | dom |
8451 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8452 | regex | | | | reg | reg |
8453 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8454 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8455 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008456
8457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020084587.1.1. Matching booleans
8459------------------------
8460
8461In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8462Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8463When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8464that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8465
8466Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8467return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8468"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8469
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020084717.1.2. Matching integers
8472------------------------
8473
8474Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8475enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8476to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8477
8478Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8479matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8480lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008481
8482For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8483unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8484representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8485
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008486As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8487two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8488instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8489ranges and operators.
8490
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008491For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008492operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8493Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8494of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008495
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008496Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008497
8498 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8499 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8500 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8501 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8502 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008504For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008505
8506 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8507
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008508This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8509
8510 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8511
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085137.1.3. Matching strings
8514-----------------------
8515
8516String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8517different forms :
8518
8519 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8520 patterns ;
8521
8522 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8523 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8524
8525 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8526 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8527
8528 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8529 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8530
8531 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8532 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8533 matches.
8534
8535 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8536 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8537 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008538
8539String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8540exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8541characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8542string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8543to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008544before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008545
8546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085477.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8548---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008549
8550Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8551they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8552possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8553passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8554the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008555the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8556match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008557
8558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085597.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8560-------------------------------------
8561
8562It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8563not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8564a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8565to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8566digits may be used upper or lower case.
8567
8568Example :
8569 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
8570 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
8571
8572
85737.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
8574---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008575
8576IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8577netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8578within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008579host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008580difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8581at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8582does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8583parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008584
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008585IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8586Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8587trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8588IPv6 patterns.
8589
8590HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8591following situations :
8592 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8593 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8594 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8595 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8596 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8597 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8598 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8599 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8600 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8601 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008603
86047.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
8605----------------------------------
8606
8607Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8608combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
8609
8610 - AND (implicit)
8611 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8612 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008614A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008616 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008618Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8619indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008621For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8622"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8623requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8624is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
8625
8626 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8627 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8628 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8629 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
8630
8631To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8632and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
8633
8634 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8635 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8636 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8637 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
8638
8639 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8640 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8641 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8642 use_backend www if host_www
8643
8644It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8645expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8646be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8647the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
8648
8649 The following rule :
8650
8651 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8652 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8653
8654 Can also be written that way :
8655
8656 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8657
8658It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8659to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8660simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8661sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8662good use is the following :
8663
8664 With named ACLs :
8665
8666 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8667 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8668 monitor fail if site_dead
8669
8670 With anonymous ACLs :
8671
8672 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8673
8674See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
8675
8676
86777.3. Fetching samples
8678---------------------
8679
8680Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
8681against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
8682sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
8683ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
8684of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
8685available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
8686
8687This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
8688Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
8689compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
8690deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
8691
8692The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
8693matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
8694method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
8695indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
8696
8697As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
8698when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
8699mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
8700the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
8701ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
8702
8703Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
8704multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
8705when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
8706incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
8707are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
8708is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
8709all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
8710
8711Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
8712 - name
8713 - name(arg1)
8714 - name(arg1,arg2)
8715
8716At the moment, the stickiness features are the most advanced users of the
8717sample fetch system. The "stick on", and "stick store-request" directives
8718support sample fetch rules which allow a list of transformations to be applied
8719on top of the fetched sample, and the finaly result is automatically converted
8720to the type of the table. These transformations are enumerated as a series
Willy Tarreau833cc792013-07-24 15:34:19 +02008721of specific keywords after the sample fetch method. These keywords may equally
8722be appended immediately after the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a
8723comma. These keywords can also support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which
8724must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008726The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008728 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
8729 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8730 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008732 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
8733 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
8734 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008736 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
8737 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
8738 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8739 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8740 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8741
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02008742 http_date([<offset>])
8743 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
8744 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
8745 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
8746 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
8747 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
8748 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
8749 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
8750 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008751
87527.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
8753--------------------------------------------
8754
8755A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
8756not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
8757"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
8758The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
8759
8760always_false : boolean
8761 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8762 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8763
8764always_true : boolean
8765 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
8766 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8767
8768avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008769 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008770 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
8771 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
8772 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
8773 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
8774 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
8775 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
8776 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
8777 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
8778 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
8779 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
8780 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
8781 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
8782 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008784be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008785 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8786 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8787 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8788 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8789 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008791be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
8792 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8793 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8794 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
8795 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
8796 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
8797 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008798
8799 Example :
8800 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8801 backend dynamic
8802 mode http
8803 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8804 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008806connslots([<backend>]) : integer
8807 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
8808 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
8809 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
8810 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008811
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008812 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008813 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008814 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8815
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008816 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8817 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008818
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008819 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008820 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008821 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008822 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8823 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008824 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008825 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008826
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008827 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8828 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008829 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008830 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008831
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02008832date([<offset>]) : integer
8833 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
8834 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
8835 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
8836 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02008837 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
8838
8839 Example :
8840
8841 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
8842 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02008843
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02008844env(<name>) : string
8845 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
8846 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
8847 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
8848 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
8849 certain way.
8850
8851 Examples :
8852 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
8853 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
8854
8855 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
8856 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
8857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008858fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
8859 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008860 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8861 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008862 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
8863 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
8864 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
8865 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
8866 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008868fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
8869 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8870 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
8871 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
8872 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
8873 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
8874 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
8875 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
8876 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008877
8878 Example :
8879 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8880 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8881 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8882 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8883 frontend mail
8884 bind :25
8885 mode tcp
8886 maxconn 100
8887 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8888 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8889 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8890 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008892nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
8893 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
8894 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
8895 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008896 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8897 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8898 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008900queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008901 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8902 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8903 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008904 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
8905 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
8906 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
8907 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
8908 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
8909
8910srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
8911 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
8912 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
8913 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
8914 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
8915 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
8916 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
8917 methods.
8918
8919srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
8920 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8921 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8922 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
8923 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
8924 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
8925 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
8926 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8927
8928srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
8929 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
8930 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
8931 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
8932 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
8933 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
8934 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
8935 overloading servers).
8936
8937 Example :
8938 # Redirect to a separate back
8939 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8940 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8941 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8942
8943table_avl([<table>]) : integer
8944 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8945 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8946
8947table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
8948 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8949 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8950 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8951
8952
89537.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
8954----------------------------------
8955
8956The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
8957closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
8958methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
8959sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
8960TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02008961the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
8962counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
8963"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02008964argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
8965the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
8966this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008967
8968be_id : integer
8969 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
8970 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
8971
8972dst : ip
8973 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
8974 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
8975 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8976 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
8977 RFC 4291.
8978
8979dst_conn : integer
8980 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
8981 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
8982 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
8983 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
8984 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8985 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8986 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
8987 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008989dst_port : integer
8990 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
8991 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
8992 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
8993 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
8994 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
8995 an HTTP header.
8996
8997fe_id : integer
8998 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
8999 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9000 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9001
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009002sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9003sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9004sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9005sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009006 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9007 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9008 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9009
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009010sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9011sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9012sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9013sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009014 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9015 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9016 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9017
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009018sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9019sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9020sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9021sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009022 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9023 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009024 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9025 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9026 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009027
9028 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9029 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009030 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9031 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9032 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009033 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9034 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9035
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009036sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9037sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9038sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9039sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009040 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9041 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9042
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009043sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9044sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9045sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9046sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009047 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9048 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9049 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9050
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009051sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9052sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9053sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9054sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009055 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9056 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9057 See also src_conn_rate.
9058
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009059sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9060sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9061sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9062sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009063 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009064 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009065
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009066sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9067sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9068sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9069sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009070 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9071 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9072 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009073 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9074 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9075 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009076
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009077sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9078sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9079sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9080sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009081 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9082 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9083 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9084
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009085sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9086sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9087sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9088sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009089 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9090 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9091 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9092 src_http_err_rate.
9093
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009094sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9095sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9096sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9097sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009098 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9099 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9100 src_http_req_cnt.
9101
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009102sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9103sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9104sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9105sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009106 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9107 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9108 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9109 src_http_req_rate.
9110
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009111sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9112sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9113sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9114sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009115 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009116 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9117 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9118 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9119 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009120
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009121 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9122 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009123 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9124
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009125sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9126sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9127sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9128sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009129 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9130 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9131 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9132 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9133
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009134sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9135sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9136sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9137sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009138 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9139 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9140 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9141 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9142
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009143sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9144sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9145sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9146sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009147 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9148 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9149 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9150 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009151 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009152 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9153
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009154sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9155sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9156sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9157sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009158 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9159 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9160 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9161 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9162 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009163 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009164
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009165sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9166sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9167sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9168sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009169 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9170 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9171 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9172
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009173sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9174sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9175sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9176sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009177 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9178 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009179 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009180 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9181 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009182 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9183 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9184 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009186so_id : integer
9187 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9188 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9189 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009191src : ip
9192 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9193 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9194 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9195 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9196 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9197 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9198 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009200src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9201 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9202 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9203 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009204 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009206src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9207 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9208 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009209 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009210 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009212src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9213 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9214 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9215 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9216 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9217 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9218 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009219
9220 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9221 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9222 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9223 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009224 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009225 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9226 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009228src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009229 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009230 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009231 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009232 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009234src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009235 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009236 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9237 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009238 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009240src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9241 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9242 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9243 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009244 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009246src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009247 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009248 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009249 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009250 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009252src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009253 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009254 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009255 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9256 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009257 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9258 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9259 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009261src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9262 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9263 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009264 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009265 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009266 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009268src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9269 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9270 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9271 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9272 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009273 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009275src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9276 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9277 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9278 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009279 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009281src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9282 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9283 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9284 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009285 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009286 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009288src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9289 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9290 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9291 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009292 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009293 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9294 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009295
9296 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009297 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009298 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009300src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9301 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9302 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9303 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9304 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009305 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9306 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009308src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9309 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9310 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009311 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9312 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009313 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009315src_port : integer
9316 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9317 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9318 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9319 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009321src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9322 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009323 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9324 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9325 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009326 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009328src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9329 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9330 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9331 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9332 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009333 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009335src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9336 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9337 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9338 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9339 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9340 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9341 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9342 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9343 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009344
9345 Example :
9346 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9347 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9348 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9349 listen ssh
9350 bind :22
9351 mode tcp
9352 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009353 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009354 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009355 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009357srv_id : integer
9358 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9359 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9360 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009361
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093637.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9364----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009366The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9367closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9368when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9369usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9370future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009372ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9373 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9374 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9375 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9376 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9377 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009379ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9380 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9381 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9382 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9383 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009385ssl_c_err : integer
9386 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9387 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9388 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9389 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9390 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009392ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9393 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9394 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9395 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9396 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9397 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9398 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9399 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9400 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009402 ACL derivatives :
9403 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009405ssl_c_key_alg : string
9406 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9407 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9408 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009410 ACL derivatives :
9411 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009413ssl_c_notafter : string
9414 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9415 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9416 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009418 ACL derivatives :
9419 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009421ssl_c_notbefore : string
9422 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9423 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9424 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009426 ACL derivatives :
9427 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009429ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9430 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9431 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9432 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9433 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9434 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9435 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9436 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9437 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009439 ACL derivatives :
9440 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009442ssl_c_serial : binary
9443 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9444 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9445 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009447 ACL derivatives :
9448 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009450ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9451 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9452 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9453 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009455ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9456 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9457 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9458 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009460 ACL derivatives :
9461 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9462
9463ssl_c_used : boolean
9464 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9465 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009467ssl_c_verify : integer
9468 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9469 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9470 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9471 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009473ssl_c_version : integer
9474 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9475 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009477ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9478 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9479 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9480 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9481 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009482 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009483 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9484 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9485 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009487 ACL derivatives :
9488 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009490ssl_f_key_alg : string
9491 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9492 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9493 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009495 ACL derivatives :
9496 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009498ssl_f_notafter : string
9499 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9500 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9501 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009503 ACL derivatives :
9504 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009506ssl_f_notbefore : string
9507 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9508 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9509 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009511 ACL derivatives :
9512 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009514ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9515 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9516 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9517 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9518 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9519 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9520 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9521 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9522 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009524 ACL derivatives :
9525 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009527ssl_f_serial : binary
9528 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9529 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9530 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009532 ACL derivatives :
9533 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009535ssl_f_sig_alg : string
9536 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9537 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9538 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009540 ACL derivatives :
9541 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009543ssl_f_version : integer
9544 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9545 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9546
9547ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009548 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9549 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
9550 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
9551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009552 Example :
9553 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
9554 listen http-https
9555 bind :80
9556 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
9557 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
9558
9559ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
9560 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
9561 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9562
9563ssl_fc_alpn : string
9564 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
9565 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
9566 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
9567 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
9568 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
9569 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
9570 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
9571 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
9572 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
9573
9574 ACL derivatives :
9575 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009577ssl_fc_cipher : string
9578 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
9579 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009581 ACL derivatives :
9582 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009584ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009585 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
9586 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009587 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
9588 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
9589 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
9590 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009592ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
9593 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009594 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
9595 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
9596 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9597 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009599ssl_fc_npn : string
9600 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
9601 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
9602 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
9603 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9604 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
9605 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
9606 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
9607 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009609 ACL derivatives :
9610 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009612ssl_fc_protocol : string
9613 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
9614 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009616 ACL derivatives :
9617 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
9618
9619ssl_fc_session_id : binary
9620 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
9621 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
9622 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
9623 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009625ssl_fc_sni : string
9626 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
9627 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9628 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
9629 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
9630 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
9631
9632 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
9633 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
9634 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02009635 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
9636 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009638 ACL derivatives :
9639 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
9640 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
9641 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009643ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
9644 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
9645 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009646
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096487.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
9649------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02009650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009651Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
9652sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
9653only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
9654For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
9655be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
9656can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
9657sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
9658for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
9659content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009661payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
9662 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
9663 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
9664 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009666payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
9667 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
9668 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
9669 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009671req.len : integer
9672req_len : integer (deprecated)
9673 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9674 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9675 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9676 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9677 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9678 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9679 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
9680 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009682req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9683 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +02009684 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
9685 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
9686 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
9687 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009689 ACL alternatives :
9690 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009692req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9693 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9694 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9695 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9696 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009698 ACL alternatives :
9699 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009701 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009703req.proto_http : boolean
9704req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
9705 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
9706 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
9707 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
9708 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
9709 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
9710 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
9711 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009713 Example:
9714 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9715 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9716 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009717 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009719req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
9720rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9721 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
9722 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
9723 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
9724 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
9725 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
9726 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
9727 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009729 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
9730 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
9731 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9732 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
9733 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
9734 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009736 ACL derivatives :
9737 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009739 Example :
9740 listen tse-farm
9741 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9742 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9743 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9744 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9745 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9746 persist rdp-cookie
9747 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9748 # This is only useful makes sense if
9749 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9750 stick-table type string size 204800
9751 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9752 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9753 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009755 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
9756 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009758req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
9759rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
9760 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
9761 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
9762 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
9763 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009765 ACL derivatives :
9766 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009768req.ssl_hello_type : integer
9769req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9770 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9771 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
9772 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9773 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9774 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
9775 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9776 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009778req.ssl_sni : string
9779req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
9780 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
9781 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
9782 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
9783 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9784 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9785 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
9786 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
9787 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
9788 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
9789 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
9790 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
9791 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009793 ACL derivatives :
9794 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009796 Examples :
9797 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
9798 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9799 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
9800 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
9801 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009803res.ssl_hello_type : integer
9804rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
9805 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
9806 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
9807 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
9808 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
9809 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
9810 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
9811 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02009812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009813req.ssl_ver : integer
9814req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
9815 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
9816 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
9817 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
9818 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
9819 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
9820 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
9821 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
9822 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
9823 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009825 ACL derivatives :
9826 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009827
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +02009828res.len : integer
9829 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
9830 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
9831 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
9832 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
9833 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
9834 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
9835 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
9836 content inspection.
9837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009838res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
9839 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +02009840 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
9841 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
9842 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
9843 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009845res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
9846 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9847 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9848 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
9849 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009851 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009853wait_end : boolean
9854 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
9855 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
9856 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
9857 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
9858 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
9859 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
9860 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
9861 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009863 Examples :
9864 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
9865 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
9866 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009868 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
9869 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
9870 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
9871 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
9872 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
9873 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
9874 tcp-request content reject
9875
9876
98777.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
9878--------------------------------------
9879
9880It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
9881This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
9882data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
9883its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
9884HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
9885content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
9886to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
9887more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
9888response are indexed.
9889
9890base : string
9891 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
9892 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
9893 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
9894 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
9895 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9896 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
9897 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
9898 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
9899
9900 ACL derivatives :
9901 base : exact string match
9902 base_beg : prefix match
9903 base_dir : subdir match
9904 base_dom : domain match
9905 base_end : suffix match
9906 base_len : length match
9907 base_reg : regex match
9908 base_sub : substring match
9909
9910base32 : integer
9911 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
9912 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
9913 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
9914 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
9915
9916base32+src : binary
9917 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
9918 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
9919 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
9920 per-URL counters.
9921
9922req.cook([<name>]) : string
9923cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9924 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9925 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
9926 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
9927 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
9928 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
9929 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
9930 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
9931 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
9932
9933 ACL derivatives :
9934 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
9935 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
9936 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
9937 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
9938 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
9939 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
9940 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
9941 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009943req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
9944cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
9945 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
9946 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009948req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
9949cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
9950 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9951 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
9952 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
9953 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009955cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
9956 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
9957 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
9958 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
9959 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
9960 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9961 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
9962 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
9963 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
9964 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
9965 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009967hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
9968 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
9969 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
9970 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
9971 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
9972 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009974req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
9975 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
9976 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
9977 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
9978 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
9979 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
9980 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
9981 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
9982 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009984req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
9985 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
9986 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
9987 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
9988 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009990req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
9991 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
9992 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
9993 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
9994 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
9995 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
9996 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
9997 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
9998 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
9999 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10000 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10001 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010003 ACL derivatives :
10004 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10005 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10006 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10007 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10008 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10009 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10010 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10011 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10012
10013req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10014hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10015 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10016 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10017 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10018 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10019 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10020 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10021 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10022 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10023 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10024
10025req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10026hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10027 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10028 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10029 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10030 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10031 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10032 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10033 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10034 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10035
10036req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10037hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10038 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10039 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10040 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10041 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10042 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10043 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10044 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10045
10046http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10047 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10048 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10049 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10050 basic auth is supported.
10051
10052http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10053 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10054 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10055 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10056 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10057 basic auth is supported.
10058
10059 ACL derivatives :
10060 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10061
10062http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010063 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10064 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010065 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10066 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010068method : integer + string
10069 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10070 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10071 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10072 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10073 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10074 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10075 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010077 ACL derivatives :
10078 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010080 Example :
10081 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10082 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10083 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010085path : string
10086 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10087 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10088 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10089 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10090 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10091 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10092 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010094 ACL derivatives :
10095 path : exact string match
10096 path_beg : prefix match
10097 path_dir : subdir match
10098 path_dom : domain match
10099 path_end : suffix match
10100 path_len : length match
10101 path_reg : regex match
10102 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010104req.ver : string
10105req_ver : string (deprecated)
10106 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10107 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10108 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010110 ACL derivatives :
10111 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010113res.comp : boolean
10114 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10115 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10116 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010118res.comp_algo : string
10119 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10120 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10121 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010123res.cook([<name>]) : string
10124scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10125 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10126 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10127 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010129 ACL derivatives :
10130 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010132res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10133scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10134 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10135 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10136 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010138res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10139scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10140 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10141 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10142 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010144res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10145 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10146 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10147 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10148 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10149 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10150 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10151 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10152 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10153 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010155res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10156 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10157 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10158 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10159 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10160 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010162res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10163shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10164 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10165 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10166 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10167 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10168 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10169 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10170 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10171 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010173 ACL derivatives :
10174 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10175 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10176 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10177 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10178 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10179 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10180 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10181 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10182
10183res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10184shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10185 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10186 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10187 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10188 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10189 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010191res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10192shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10193 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10194 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10195 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10196 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10197 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10198 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010200res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10201shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10202 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10203 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10204 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10205 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10206 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10207 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010209res.ver : string
10210resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10211 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10212 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010214 ACL derivatives :
10215 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010217set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10218 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10219 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10220 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10221 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010223 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10224 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010226 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010228status : integer
10229 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10230 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10231 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010233url : string
10234 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10235 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10236 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10237 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10238 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10239 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10240 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010242 ACL derivatives :
10243 url : exact string match
10244 url_beg : prefix match
10245 url_dir : subdir match
10246 url_dom : domain match
10247 url_end : suffix match
10248 url_len : length match
10249 url_reg : regex match
10250 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010252url_ip : ip
10253 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10254 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10255 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10256 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10257 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10258 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10259 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010261url_port : integer
10262 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10263 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10264 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10265 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010267urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10268url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10269 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10270 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10271 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10272 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10273 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10274 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10275 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10276 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10277 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010279 ACL derivatives :
10280 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10281 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10282 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10283 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10284 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10285 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10286 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10287 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010288
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010290 Example :
10291 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10292 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10293 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10294 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010296urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10297 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10298 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10299 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010300
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103027.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010303---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010305Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10306every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010307order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010309ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10310---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010311FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010312HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010313HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10314HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010315HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10316HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10317HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10318HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10319LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010320METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10321METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10322METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10323METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10324METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10325METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010326RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010327REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010328TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010329WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10330---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010331
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103338. Logging
10334----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010335
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010336One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10337provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10338very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10339provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10340state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010341to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010342headers.
10343
10344In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10345about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10346send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10347
10348 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10349 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10350 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10351 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10352 at the termination.
10353
10354The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10355allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10356as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10357while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10358real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10359delay.
10360
10361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103628.1. Log levels
10363---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010364
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010365TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010366source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010367HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10368in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10369track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10370syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10371about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010372
10373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103748.2. Log formats
10375----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010376
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010377HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010378and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10379slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10380options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010381
10382 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10383 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10384 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10385 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10386 extents.
10387
10388 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10389 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10390 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10391 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10392 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10393
10394 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10395 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10396 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10397 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10398 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10399
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010400 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10401 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10402 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10403 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10404
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010405 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10406
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010407Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10408specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10409field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10410servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10411always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10412identifier.
10413
10414Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10415 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10416 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10417 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10418 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10419
10420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104218.2.1. Default log format
10422-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010423
10424This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10425as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10426format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10427
10428 Example :
10429 listen www
10430 mode http
10431 log global
10432 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10433
10434 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10435 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10436 (www/HTTP)
10437
10438 Field Format Extract from the example above
10439 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10440 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10441 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10442 4 'to' to
10443 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10444 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10445
10446Detailed fields description :
10447 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10448 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10449 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10450 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10451 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10452 and processed the connection.
10453 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10454
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010455In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10456"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10457connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10458
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010459It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10460will eventually disappear.
10461
10462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104638.2.2. TCP log format
10464---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010465
10466The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10467is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10468information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10469counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10470emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10471environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10472the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10473sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010474specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10475not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10476fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10477marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010478
10479 Example :
10480 frontend fnt
10481 mode tcp
10482 option tcplog
10483 log global
10484 default_backend bck
10485
10486 backend bck
10487 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10488
10489 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10490 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10491 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10492
10493 Field Format Extract from the example above
10494 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10495 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10496 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10497 4 frontend_name fnt
10498 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10499 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10500 7 bytes_read* 212
10501 8 termination_state --
10502 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10503 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10504
10505Detailed fields description :
10506 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010507 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10508 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10509 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10510 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10511 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010512
10513 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010514 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10515 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10516 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010517
10518 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10519 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10520 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
10521 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
10522
10523 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10524 and processed the connection.
10525
10526 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10527 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10528 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
10529 applications.
10530
10531 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10532 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10533 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10534 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
10535 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
10536
10537 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10538 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10539 See "Timers" below for more details.
10540
10541 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10542 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10543 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
10544 "Timers" below for more details.
10545
10546 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10547 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10548 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10549 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10550 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10551 details.
10552
10553 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10554 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10555 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10556 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10557 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10558
10559 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10560 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10561 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10562 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10563 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
10564 for more details.
10565
10566 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010567 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010568 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
10569 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
10570 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010571 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010572
10573 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10574 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10575 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10576 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10577 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10578 caused by a denial of service attack.
10579
10580 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10581 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10582 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10583 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10584 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10585 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10586 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10587 denial of service attack.
10588
10589 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10590 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10591 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10592 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10593 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10594 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10595 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10596 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10597 be processed than on other servers.
10598
10599 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10600 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10601 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10602 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10603 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10604 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10605 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10606 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10607 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10608 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10609 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10610 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10611 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10612
10613 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10614 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10615 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10616 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10617 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10618 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10619 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10620 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10621
10622 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10623 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10624 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10625 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10626 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10627 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10628 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10629 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10630 occurs.
10631
10632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106338.2.3. HTTP log format
10634----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010635
10636The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10637is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10638the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10639are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10640emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10641generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10642"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10643which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010644frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10645is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010646
10647Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10648slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10649with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10650
10651 Example :
10652 frontend http-in
10653 mode http
10654 option httplog
10655 log global
10656 default_backend bck
10657
10658 backend static
10659 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10660
10661 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10662 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10663 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010664 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010665
10666 Field Format Extract from the example above
10667 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10668 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10669 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10670 4 frontend_name http-in
10671 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10672 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10673 7 status_code 200
10674 8 bytes_read* 2750
10675 9 captured_request_cookie -
10676 10 captured_response_cookie -
10677 11 termination_state ----
10678 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10679 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10680 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10681 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10682 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010683
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010684
10685Detailed fields description :
10686 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010687 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10688 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10689 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10690 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10691 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010692
10693 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010694 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10695 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10696 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010697
10698 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10699 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10700 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10701 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10702 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10703
10704 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10705 and processed the connection.
10706
10707 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10708 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10709 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10710
10711 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10712 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10713 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10714 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10715 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10716 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10717
10718 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10719 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10720 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10721 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10722 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10723 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10724
10725 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10726 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10727 See "Timers" below for more details.
10728
10729 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10730 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10731 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10732 below for more details.
10733
10734 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10735 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10736 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10737 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10738 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10739 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10740 for more details.
10741
10742 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10743 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10744 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10745 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10746 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10747 details.
10748
10749 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10750 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10751 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10752
10753 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10754 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10755 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10756 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10757 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10758 overflowing.
10759
10760 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10761 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10762 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10763 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10764 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10765 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10766 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10767 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10768
10769 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10770 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10771 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10772 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10773 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10774 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10775 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10776 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10777
10778 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10779 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10780 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10781 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10782 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10783 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10784 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10785
10786 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010787 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010788 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10789 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10790 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010791 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010792 system.
10793
10794 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10795 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10796 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10797 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10798 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10799 caused by a denial of service attack.
10800
10801 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10802 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10803 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10804 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10805 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10806 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10807 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10808 denial of service attack.
10809
10810 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10811 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10812 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10813 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10814 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10815 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10816 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10817 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10818 processed than on other servers.
10819
10820 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10821 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10822 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10823 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10824 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10825 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10826 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10827 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10828 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10829 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10830 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10831 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10832 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10833
10834 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10835 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10836 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10837 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10838 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10839 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10840 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10841 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10842
10843 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10844 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10845 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10846 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10847 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10848 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10849 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10850 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10851 occurs.
10852
10853 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10854 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10855 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10856 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10857 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10858 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10859 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10860 cookies" below for more details.
10861
10862 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10863 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10864 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10865 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10866 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10867 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10868 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10869 and cookies" below for more details.
10870
10871 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10872 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10873 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10874 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10875 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10876 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10877 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10878 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10879
10880
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200108818.2.4. Custom log format
10882------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010883
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010884The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010885mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010886
10887HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10888Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10889separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10890prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10891
10892Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10893variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10894string formats ("Q").
10895
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010896If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010897as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010898less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10899the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10900
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010901Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10902HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10903
10904Flags are :
10905 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010906 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010907
10908 Example:
10909
10910 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10911 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10912
10913At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10914
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010915 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10916 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010917
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010918the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010919
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010920 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010921 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010922 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010923
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010924and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10925
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010926 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010927 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10928
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010929Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10930
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010931 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010932 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010933 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10934 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10935 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010936 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10937 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10938 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010939 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010940 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010941 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010942 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010943 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010944 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010945 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10946 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010947 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010948 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10949 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010950 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010951 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10952 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010953 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10954 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
10955 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010956 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010957 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
10958 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010959 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010960 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10961 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
10962 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010963 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010964 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10965 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10966 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10967 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010968 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010969 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010970 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010971 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010972 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010973 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010974 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
10975 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
10976 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010977 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010978 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10979 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010980 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010981 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010982 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010983 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010984
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010985 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010986
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010010987
109888.2.5. Error log format
10989-----------------------
10990
10991When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
10992protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
10993By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
10994"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
10995will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
10996logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
10997
10998The format looks like this :
10999
11000 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11001 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11002 Connection error during SSL handshake
11003
11004 Field Format Extract from the example above
11005 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11006 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11007 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11008 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11009 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11010
11011These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11012failures.
11013
11014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110158.3. Advanced logging options
11016-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011017
11018Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11019just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11020options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11021for more information about their usage.
11022
11023
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110248.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11025------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011026
11027It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11028haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11029commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11030monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11031ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11032
11033 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11034 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11035 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11036 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11037
11038 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11039 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11040 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11041 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11042 such as other load-balancers.
11043
11044 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11045 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11046 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11047
11048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110498.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11050----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011051
11052The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11053what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11054or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11055"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11056just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11057log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11058after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11059is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11060with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11061with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11062
11063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110648.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11065------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011066
11067Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11068for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11069"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11070retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11071raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11072a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11073file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11074you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11075"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11076
11077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110788.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11079--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011080
11081Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11082multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11083them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11084"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11085logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11086error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11087and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11088too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11089useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11090alternative.
11091
11092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110938.4. Timing events
11094------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011095
11096Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11097reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11098the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11099frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11100mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11101
11102 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11103 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11104 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11105 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11106 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11107
11108 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11109 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11110 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11111 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11112 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11113
11114 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11115 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11116 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11117 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11118 connection never established.
11119
11120 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11121 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11122 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11123 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11124 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11125 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11126 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11127 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11128 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11129 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11130 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11131
11132 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11133 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11134 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11135 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11136 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11137
11138 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11139
11140 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11141 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11142 negative.
11143
11144These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11145protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11146that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011147due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011148close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11149session has been aborted on timeout.
11150
11151Most common cases :
11152
11153 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11154 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11155 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11156 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11157 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11158 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11159 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11160 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11161 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011162 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11163 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11164 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011165
11166 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11167 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11168 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11169 of ms on remote networks.
11170
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011171 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11172 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11173 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011174
11175 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11176 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11177 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11178 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11179 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11180 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11181 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11182 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11183 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11184 to the server until another one is released.
11185
11186Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11187
11188 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11189 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11190 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11191
11192 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11193 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11194 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11195
11196 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11197 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11198 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11199 flags.
11200
11201 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11202 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11203 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11204 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11205 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11206 the client connection was maintained open.
11207
11208 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11209 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11210 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11211 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11212
11213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112148.5. Session state at disconnection
11215-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011216
11217TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11218"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
112192-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11220each of which has a special meaning :
11221
11222 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11223 session to terminate :
11224
11225 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11226
11227 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11228 server explicitly refused it.
11229
11230 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11231 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11232 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11233 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011234 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11235
11236 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11237 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011238
11239 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11240 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11241 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11242 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11243 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11244
11245 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11246 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11247 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11248 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11249 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11250
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011251 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11252 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11253
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011254 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11255 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11256 backup connections when going up.
11257
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011258 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11259
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011260 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11261 send or receive data.
11262
11263 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11264 send or receive data.
11265
11266 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11267 with nothing left in the buffers.
11268
11269 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11270
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011271 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011272 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11273
11274 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11275 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11276 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11277 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11278 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11279
11280 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11281 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11282
11283 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11284 server (HTTP only).
11285
11286 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11287
11288 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11289 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11290 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11291
11292 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11293 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11294 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11295
11296 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11297
11298 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11299 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11300
11301 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11302 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11303 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11304
11305 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11306 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011307 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11308 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011309
11310 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11311 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11312 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11313 another server.
11314
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011315 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011316 server.
11317
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011318 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11319 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11320 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11321 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11322
11323 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11324 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11325 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11326 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11327
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011328 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11329 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11330 "use-server" rule).
11331
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011332 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11333
11334 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11335 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11336
11337 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11338
11339 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11340 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11341 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11342
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011343 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11344 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11345 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11346 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11347 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11348
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011349 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11350
11351 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11352 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11353
11354 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11355
11356 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11357
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011358The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11359was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011360helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11361starvation, attacks, etc...
11362
11363The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11364alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11365easier finding and understanding.
11366
11367 Flags Reason
11368
11369 -- Normal termination.
11370
11371 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11372 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11373 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11374 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11375
11376 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11377 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11378 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11379 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11380 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11381 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011382
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011383 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11384 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011385 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011386
11387 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11388 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11389 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11390
11391 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11392 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11393 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11394 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11395 the server takes too long to respond.
11396
11397 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11398 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11399 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11400 long a time to respond.
11401
11402 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11403 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11404 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11405 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11406 and the client.
11407
11408 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11409 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11410 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11411 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11412 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11413 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11414
11415 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11416 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011417 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11418 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11419 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11420 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011421
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011422 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11423 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011425 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011426 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11427 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11428 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11429 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11430 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11431
11432 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11433 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11434 503 or 504 here.
11435
11436 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11437 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11438 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11439 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11440 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11441
11442 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11443 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011444 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011445 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11446 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11447
11448 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11449 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11450 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11451 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11452 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11453 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11454 between haproxy and the server.
11455
11456 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11457 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11458 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11459 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11460 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11461 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11462 solution is to fix the application.
11463
11464 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11465 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11466 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11467 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11468 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11469 external attacks.
11470
11471 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11472 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011473 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011474 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11475 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11476
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011477 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11478 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11479 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011480 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11481 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011482
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011483 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11484 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11485 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11486 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011487 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11488 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11489 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11490 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11491 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011492
11493 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11494 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11495 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11496 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11497
11498 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11499 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11500 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11501 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11502
11503 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11504 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11505 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11506 only be solved by proper system tuning.
11507
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011508The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
11509persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
11510important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11511re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11512
11513 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11514
11515 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11516 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11517 set on a GET request.
11518
11519 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
11520 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011521 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011522 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
11523
11524 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
11525 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
11526 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
11527
11528 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11529 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
11530 already got a cookie.
11531
11532 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11533 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
11534 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
11535 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
11536 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
11537
11538 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11539 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11540 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11541
11542 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
11543 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11544 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11545
11546 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
11547 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
11548
11549 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
11550 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
11551 then advertised in the response.
11552
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115548.6. Non-printable characters
11555-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011556
11557In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11558consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11559converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11560prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11561being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11562escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
11563is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
11564'}' when logging headers.
11565
11566Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
11567issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
11568containing spaces is "User-Agent".
11569
11570Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
11571the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
11572performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
11573
11574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115758.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
11576---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011577
11578Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
11579achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011580section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011581cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
11582the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
11583the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011584locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011585not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
11586user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
11587a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
11588wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
11589
11590 Examples :
11591 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
11592 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
11593
11594 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
11595 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
11596
11597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115988.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11599---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011600
11601Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11602proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11603the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11604server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11605
11606Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11607response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011608section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011609
11610It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011611time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11612appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011613are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11614and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11615follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11616request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11617in the logs.
11618
11619 Example :
11620 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11621 listen proxy-out
11622 mode http
11623 option httplog
11624 option logasap
11625 log global
11626 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11627
11628 # log the name of the virtual server
11629 capture request header Host len 20
11630
11631 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11632 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11633
11634 # log the beginning of the referrer
11635 capture request header Referer len 20
11636
11637 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11638 capture response header Server len 20
11639
11640 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11641 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11642
11643 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11644 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11645
11646 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11647 capture response header Via len 20
11648
11649 # log the URL location during a redirection
11650 capture response header Location len 20
11651
11652 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11653 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11654 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11655 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11656 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11657
11658 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11659 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11660 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11661 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011662 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011663
11664 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11665 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11666 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11667 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11668 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011669 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011670
11671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116728.9. Examples of logs
11673---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011674
11675These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11676them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11677reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11678
11679 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11680 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11681 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11682
11683 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11684 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11685
11686 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11687 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11688 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11689
11690 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11691 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11692
11693 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11694 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11695 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11696
11697 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011698 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011699 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11700 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11701
11702 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11703 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11704 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11705
11706 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11707 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011708 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011709 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11710 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11711 to return the 502 and not the server.
11712
11713 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011714 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011715
11716 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11717 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11718 Nothing was sent to any server.
11719
11720 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11721 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11722
11723 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11724 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11725 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11726 send a 408 return code to the client.
11727
11728 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11729 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11730
11731 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11732 5 seconds ("c----").
11733
11734 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11735 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011736 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011737
11738 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011739 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011740 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11741 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11742 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11743 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11744 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011745
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011746
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117479. Statistics and monitoring
11748----------------------------
11749
11750It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11751mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11752CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11753Unix socket.
11754
11755
117569.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011757---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011758
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011759The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11760page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11761
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011762 0. pxname: proxy name
11763 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11764 for server)
11765 2. qcur: current queued requests
11766 3. qmax: max queued requests
11767 4. scur: current sessions
11768 5. smax: max sessions
11769 6. slim: sessions limit
11770 7. stot: total sessions
11771 8. bin: bytes in
11772 9. bout: bytes out
11773 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011774 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011775 12. ereq: request errors
11776 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011777 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011778 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11779 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011780 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011781 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11782 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11783 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11784 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11785 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11786 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11787 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11788 25. qlimit: queue limit
11789 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11790 27. iid: unique proxy id
11791 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11792 29. throttle: warm up status
11793 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11794 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011795 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011796 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11797 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11798 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011799 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011800 UNK -> unknown
11801 INI -> initializing
11802 SOCKERR -> socket error
11803 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11804 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11805 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11806 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11807 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11808 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11809 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11810 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11811 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11812 disable-on-404
11813 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11814 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11815 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011816 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11817 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011818 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11819 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11820 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11821 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11822 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11823 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011824 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11825 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11826 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11827 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011828 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11829 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011830 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11831 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11832 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011833 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011834
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118369.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011837-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011838
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020011839The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
11840necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
11841A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
11842issuing commands by hand :
11843
11844 global
11845 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
11846 stats timeout 2m
11847
11848It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
11849the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
11850never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
11851situations :
11852
11853 global
11854 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
11855 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
11856 stats timeout 2m
11857
11858To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
11859swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
11860to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
11861syntaxes we'll use are the following :
11862
11863 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
11864 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
11865
11866The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
11867script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
11868for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
11869
11870The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
11871that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
11872editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
11873(eg: watch a counter).
11874
11875The socket supports two operation modes :
11876 - interactive
11877 - non-interactive
11878
11879The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
11880this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
11881sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
11882mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
11883commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
11884example :
11885
11886 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
11887
11888The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
11889entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
11890for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
11891sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
11892"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
11893after processing the last command of the same line.
11894
11895For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
11896"prompt" command :
11897
11898 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
11899 prompt
11900 > show info
11901 ...
11902 >
11903
11904Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
11905delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
11906that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
11907parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011908
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011909It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11910on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11911own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011912
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020011913The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
11914If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
11915all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
11916it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
11917
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011918clear counters
11919 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11920 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11921 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11922 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11923 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11924
11925clear counters all
11926 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11927 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11928 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11929
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011930clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11931 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11932
11933 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11934 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11935 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11936 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11937 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11938 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11939
11940 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11941
11942 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11943 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11944 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11945 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11946 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11947 the ACLs :
11948
11949 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11950 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11951 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11952 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11953 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11954 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11955
11956 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011957 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11958 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011959
11960 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011961 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011962 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011963 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11964 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11965 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11966 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011967
11968 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11969
11970 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011971 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011972 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11973 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011974 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11975 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11976 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011977
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011978disable frontend <frontend>
11979 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11980 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11981 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11982 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11983 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11984 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11985 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11986 on the stats page.
11987
11988 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11989 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11990
11991 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11992 level "admin".
11993
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011994disable server <backend>/<server>
11995 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11996 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11997 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11998 during the maintenance.
11999
12000 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12001 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12002
12003 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012004 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012005
12006 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12007 level "admin".
12008
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012009enable frontend <frontend>
12010 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12011 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12012 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12013 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12014 which was disabled.
12015
12016 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12017 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12018
12019 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12020 level "admin".
12021
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012022enable server <backend>/<server>
12023 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12024 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12025
12026 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012027 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012028
12029 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12030 level "admin".
12031
12032get weight <backend>/<server>
12033 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12034 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12035 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12036 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12037 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012038 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012039
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012040help
12041 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12042 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012043
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012044prompt
12045 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12046 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12047 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12048 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12049 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12050 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12051 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12052 command.
12053
12054quit
12055 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012056
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012057set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012058 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12059 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12060 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12061 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12062 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012063 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12064 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12065
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012066set maxconn global <maxconn>
12067 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12068 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12069 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12070 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12071 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12072 setting.
12073
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012074set rate-limit connections global <value>
12075 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12076 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12077 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12078 is passed in number of connections per second.
12079
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012080set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12081 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12082 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012083 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12084 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012085
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012086set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012087 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12088 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12089 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12090 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012091 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12092 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012093
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012094set timeout cli <delay>
12095 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12096 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12097 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12098
12099set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12100 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12101 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012102 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12103 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12104 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12105 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12106 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12107 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12108 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12109 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12110 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12111 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12112 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12113 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12114 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012115
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012116show errors [<iid>]
12117 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12118 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012119 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12120 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12121 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012122
12123 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12124 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12125 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12126 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12127 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12128 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12129 are reported too.
12130
12131 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12132 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12133 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12134 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12135 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12136 code.
12137
12138 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12139 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12140 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12141 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12142 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12143 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12144 line.
12145
12146 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012147 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12148 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012149 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12150 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12151
12152 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12153 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12154 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12155 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12156 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12157 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12158 00204+ minal\r\n
12159 00211 \r\n
12160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012161 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012162 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12163 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12164 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12165 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12166 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12167 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012168
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012169show info
12170 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12171
12172show sess
12173 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012174 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12175 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12176
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012177show sess <id>
12178 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12179 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12180 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12181 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12182 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012183 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12184 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12185 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012186
12187show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12188 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12189 possible to dump only selected items :
12190 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12191 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12192 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12193 for example:
12194 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12195 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12196 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12197
12198 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012199 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12200 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012201 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12202 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12203 Nbproc: 1
12204 Process_num: 1
12205 (...)
12206
12207 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12208 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12209 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12210 (...)
12211 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12212
12213 $
12214
12215 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12216 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12217 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12218 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012219 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012220
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012221show table
12222 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12223 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12224 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12225 entries currently in use.
12226
12227 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012228 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012229 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12230 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012231
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012232show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012233 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12234 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12235 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012236 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12237
12238 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12239 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12240 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12241 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12242 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12243
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012244 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12245 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12246 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12247 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12248 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12249 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12250
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012251
12252 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012253 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12254 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012255
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012256 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012257 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012258 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012259 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12260 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12261 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12262 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012263
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012264 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012265 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012266 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12267 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012268
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012269 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12270 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012271 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012272 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12273 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012274
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012275 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12276 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012277 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012278 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12279 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12280
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012281 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12282 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12283 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12284 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12285 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12286
12287 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12288 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12289 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012290 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12291 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012292 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12293 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012294
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012295shutdown frontend <frontend>
12296 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12297 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12298 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12299 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12300 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12301 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12302 once it is terminated.
12303
12304 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12305 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12306
12307 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12308 level "admin".
12309
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012310shutdown session <id>
12311 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12312 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12313 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12314 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12315 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12316 flag in the logs.
12317
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012318shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12319 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12320 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12321 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12322 'K' flag in the logs.
12323
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012324/*
12325 * Local variables:
12326 * fill-column: 79
12327 * End:
12328 */